blob: cb54998518cd3d3e01aa75d65c0d1e24bf28eb1c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau5902ad92021-02-06 10:49:57 +01007 2021/02/06
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand83972542020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700408 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001084 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001282 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1283 field is stripped. This is the default.
1284 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1285 rfc3164.
1286
1287 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001288 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1289
1290 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1291 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1292
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001293 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1294 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1295 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1296 designed to be used with a local log server.
1297
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001298 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1299 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1300 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1301 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1302 logger consumes.
1303
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001304 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1305 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1306 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1307 used with a local log server.
1308
1309 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1310 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1311 designed to be used with a local log server.
1312
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001313 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1314 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1315 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1316 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1317
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001318 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1319 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1320 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1321 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1322 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1323
1324 <sample_size>
1325 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1326 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1327 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1328 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1329 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1330
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001331 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001332
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001333 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1334 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1335 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1336
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001337 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1338 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1339 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1340 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341
1342 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001343 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1344 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1345 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1346 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1347 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1348 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001350 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001351
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001352log-send-hostname [<string>]
1353 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1354 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1355 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1356 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1357 the logs.
1358
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359log-tag <string>
1360 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1361 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1362 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001363 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001364
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001365lua-load <file>
1366 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1367 used multiple times.
1368
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001369lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1370 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1371 variable.
1372 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1373 to "path".
1374
1375 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1376 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1377 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1378 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1379 will be checked earlier.
1380
1381 As an example by specifying the following path:
1382
1383 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1384 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1385
1386 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1387 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1388 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1389 paths if that does not exist either.
1390
1391 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1392 documentation.
1393
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001394master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001395 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1396 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1397 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001398 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001399 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1400 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001401 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1402 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1403 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1404 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1405 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001406
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001407 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001408
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001409mworker-max-reloads <number>
1410 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001411 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001412 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1413 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1414 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1415
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001416nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001417 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1418 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1419 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001420 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1421 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001422 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1423 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1424 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001425
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001426nbthread <number>
1427 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001428 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1429 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1430 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1431 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1432 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001433 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1434 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1435 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1436 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1437 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1438 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1439 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001442 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1443 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1444 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1445 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001447pp2-never-send-local
1448 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1449 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1450 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1451 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1452 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1453 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1454 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1455 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1456 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1457 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1458 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1459
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001460presetenv <name> <value>
1461 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1462 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1463 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1464 and "unsetenv".
1465
1466resetenv [<name> ...]
1467 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1468 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1469 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1470 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1471 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1472 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1473 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1474 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1475
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001476stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001477 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1478 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1479 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1480 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1481 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1482 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001483 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001484 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1485 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1486 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1487 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001488
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001489server-state-base <directory>
1490 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001491 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1492 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001493
1494server-state-file <file>
1495 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1496 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1497 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1498 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1499 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1500 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1501 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1502 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001503 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1504 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001505
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001506setenv <name> <value>
1507 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1508 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1509 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1510 and "unsetenv".
1511
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001512set-dumpable
1513 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001514 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1515 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1516 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1517 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1518 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1519 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1520 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1521 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1522 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1523 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1524 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1525 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1526 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1527 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1528 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1529 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1530 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001531
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001532ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1534 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001535 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001536 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001537 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1538 information and recommendations see e.g.
1539 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1540 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1541 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1542 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001543
1544ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1547 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1548 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1549 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001550 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1551 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1552 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001553 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001554
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001555ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1558 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1559 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1560 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1561
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001562ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1564 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1565 keyword to see available options.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001569 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001570
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001571ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1573 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001574 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001575 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1577 information and recommendations see e.g.
1578 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1579 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1580 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1581 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1582 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001583
1584ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1586 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1587 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1588 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1589 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001590 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1591 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1592 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1593 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001595ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1598 keyword to see available options.
1599
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1602 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1603 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001606 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1607 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1608 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1609 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001610 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1611 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1612 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1613
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001614ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1615 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1616 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001617 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001618 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001619 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1620
1621 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001622
1623 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1624 and won't try to remove them.
1625
1626 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1627
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001628ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001629 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001630 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1631 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001632
1633 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1634 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1635 optimize the startup time.
1636
1637 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1638 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1639 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1640
1641 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001642 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001643
1644 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001645 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1646
1647 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1648 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1649 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1650 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1651 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1652 bind configuration..
1653
1654 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1655 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1656 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1657 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1658 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1659 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1660 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1661 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1662
1663 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1664
1665 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1666 a cert bundle.
1667
1668 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1669 separately in several "crt".
1670
1671 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1672 since files are loading separately.
1673
1674 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1675 required to commit them.
1676
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001677 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001678 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001679
1680 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1681
1682 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1683
1684 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1685 not provided in the PEM file.
1686
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001687 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1688 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1689
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001690 The default behavior is "all".
1691
1692 Example:
1693 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1694 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1695 ssl-load-extra-files none
1696
1697 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1698
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001699ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1700 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1701 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1702 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1703
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001704ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001705 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001706 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1707 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1708 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1709 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1710 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1711 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001712 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001713
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001714stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1715 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1716 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1717 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001718 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001719 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001720
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001721 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1722 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1723 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1726 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1727 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001728 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001729
1730stats maxconn <connections>
1731 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1732 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734uid <number>
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001735 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1737 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1738 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1739
1740ulimit-n <number>
1741 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1742 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1743 option.
1744
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001745unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1746 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1747
1748 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1749 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1750 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1751 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1752 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1753 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1754 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1755 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1756 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1757 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1758
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001759unsetenv [<name> ...]
1760 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1761 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1762 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1763 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1764 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1765 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1766 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768user <user name>
1769 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1770 See also "uid" and "group".
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001772node <name>
1773 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1774
1775 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1776 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1777 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1778 traffic.
1779
1780description <text>
1781 Add a text that describes the instance.
1782
1783 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1784 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1785 "<" and ">" characters.
1786
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178751degrees-data-file <file path>
1788 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001789 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001791 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001792 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1793
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000179451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1796 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1797 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1798
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001799 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001800 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1801
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200180251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001803 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1804 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1805
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001806 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1807 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1808
180951degrees-cache-size <number>
1810 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1811 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1812 By default, this cache is disabled.
1813
1814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001817wurfl-data-file <file path>
1818 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1819 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1820
1821 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1822 with USE_WURFL=1.
1823
1824wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1825 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1826 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1827 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1828
1829 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1830
1831 Valid WURFL properties are:
1832 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1833
1834 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1835 device.
1836
1837 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1838 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1839
1840 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1841 particular web request.
1842
1843 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1844 used Libwurfl API version.
1845
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001846 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1847 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1848
1849 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1850 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1851
1852 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1853
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001854 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1855 with USE_WURFL=1.
1856
1857wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1858 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1859 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1860
1861 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1862 with USE_WURFL=1.
1863
1864wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1865 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1866 thus before the chroot.
1867
1868 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1869 with USE_WURFL=1.
1870
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001871wurfl-cache-size <size>
1872 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1873 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001874 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001875 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001876
1877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001880strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001881 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1882 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1883 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1884 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1885 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018873.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888-----------------------
1889
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001890busy-polling
1891 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1892 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1893 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1894 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1895 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1896 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1897 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1898 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1899 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1900 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1901 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1902 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1903 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1904 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1905 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1906 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1907 "poll" pollers.
1908
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001909 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1910 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1911 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1912
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001913max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1914 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1915 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1916 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1917 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1918 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1919 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1920 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1921 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001923maxconn <number>
1924 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1925 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1926 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001927 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1928 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1929 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1930 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001931 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1932 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1933 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1934 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1935 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1936 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001937
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001938maxconnrate <number>
1939 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1940 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1941 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1942 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1943 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1944 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1945 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1946 fairness.
1947
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001948maxcomprate <number>
1949 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001951 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1952 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1953 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001954 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001955 default value.
1956
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001957maxcompcpuusage <number>
1958 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1959 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1960 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1961 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1962 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1963 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1964 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1965 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1966
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001967maxpipes <number>
1968 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1969 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1970 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1971 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1972 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1973 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1974
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001975maxsessrate <number>
1976 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1977 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1978 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1979 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1980 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1981 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1982 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1983 fairness.
1984
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001985maxsslconn <number>
1986 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1987 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1988 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1989 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1990 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1991 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1992 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001993 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1994 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1995 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1996 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1997 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1998 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1999 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002000
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002001maxsslrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2003 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2004 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2005 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2006 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2007 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2008 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2009 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2010 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2011 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2012
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002013maxzlibmem <number>
2014 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2015 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2016 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002017 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2018 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2019 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021noepoll
2022 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002025
2026nokqueue
2027 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2028 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2029 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2030
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002031noevports
2032 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2033 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2034 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2035 also "nopoll".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037nopoll
2038 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2039 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002041 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2042 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002043
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044nosplice
2045 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002046 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002047 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002048 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002049 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2050 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2051 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2052 "option splice-response".
2053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002054nogetaddrinfo
2055 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2056 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2057
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002058noreuseport
2059 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2060 command line argument "-dR".
2061
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002062profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2063 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2064 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2065 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2066 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002067 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002068 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2069 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2070 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2071 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2072
2073 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2074 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2075 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2076 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2077 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002078 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2079 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2080 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2081 CLI.
2082
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002083spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002084 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2085 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2086 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2087 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2088 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2089 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002092 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002093 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002094 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2095 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2096 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2097 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2098 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2100 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002101 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2102 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2103 openssl configuration file uses:
2104 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2105
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002106ssl-mode-async
2107 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002108 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002109 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2110 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2111 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002112 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002113 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002114
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002115tune.buffers.limit <number>
2116 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2117 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2118 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2119 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2120 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002122 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2123 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2124 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2125 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2126 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2127 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2128 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2129 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2130 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2131
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002132tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2133 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2134 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2135 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2136 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2137
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002138tune.bufsize <number>
2139 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2140 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2141 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2142 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2143 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2144 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2145 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002146 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2147 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2148 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002149 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002150 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2151 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2152 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002153
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002154tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2155 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002156
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002157tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2158 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2159 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2160 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2161 this value. The default value is 1.
2162
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002163tune.fail-alloc
2164 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2165 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2166 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2167 gracefully.
2168
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002169tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2170 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2171 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2172 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2173 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2174 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2175
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002176tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2177 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2178 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2179 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2180 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2181 change it.
2182
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002183tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2184 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002185 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2186 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002187 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2188 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2189 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2190 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2191 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2192
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002193tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2194 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2195 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2196 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2197 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2198 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2199 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2200 recommended not to change this value.
2201
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002202tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2203 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2204 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2205 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2206 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2207 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2208 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2209 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2210
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002211tune.http.cookielen <number>
2212 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2213 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2214 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2215 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2216 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2217 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2218 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2219 to change this value.
2220
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2223 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002224 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002225 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002226 configuration directives too.
2227 The default value is 1024.
2228
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002229tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2230 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2231 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2232 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2233 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2234 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2235 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002236 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2237 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2238 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002239
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002240tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2241 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2242 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2243 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2244 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2245 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2246 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2247 this option to "off". The default is on.
2248
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002249tune.idletimer <timeout>
2250 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2251 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2252 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2253 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2254 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2255 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002256 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002257 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002258 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2259
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002260tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2261 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2262 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2263 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2264 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2265 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2266 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2267 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2268 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2269 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2270
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002271tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2272 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002273 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002274 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2275 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002276 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002277 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2278 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2279
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002280tune.lua.maxmem
2281 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2282 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2283 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2284 memory.
2285
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002286tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2287 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002288 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2289 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002290 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002291
2292tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2293 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2294 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2295 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2296 check servers.
2297
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002298tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2299 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2300 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2301 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002303
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002304tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002305 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2306 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2307 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2308 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2309 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2310 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2311 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2312 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2313 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2314 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002315
2316tune.maxpollevents <number>
2317 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2318 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2319 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2320 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2321 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2322
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002323tune.maxrewrite <number>
2324 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2325 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2326 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2327 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2328 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2329 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2330 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2331 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2332 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2333 bufsize.
2334
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002335tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2336 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2337 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2338 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2339 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2340 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2341 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2342 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2343 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2344 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002345 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2346 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002347 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2348 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2349 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2350 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2351 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2352 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2353 setting this parameter to 0.
2354
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002355tune.pipesize <number>
2356 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2357 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2358 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2359 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2360 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2361 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2362
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002363tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2364 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2365 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2366 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2367 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2368 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2369 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002370 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002371
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002372tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2373 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2374 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2375 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2376 default is 20.
2377
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002378tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2379tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2380 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2381 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2382 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002383 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002384 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002385 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2386 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2387
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002388tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002390 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2391 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2392 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2393 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2394
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002395tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002396 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002397 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002398 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2399 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2400 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2401
2402tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2403 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2404 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2405 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2406 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2407 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2408 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2409 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2410 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2411 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002412
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002413tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2414tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2415 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2416 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2417 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002418 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002419 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002420 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2421 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2422 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2423 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2424 notifying haproxy again.
2425
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002426tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002427 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchydede64a2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002428 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2429 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2430 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2431 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2432 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2433 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2434 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2435 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2436 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2437 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2438 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002439
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002440tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002441 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002442 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2443 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2444 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2445 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2446 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2447
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002448tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2449 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2450 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2451 performances. This is disabled by default.
2452
2453 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2454 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2455
2456 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2457
2458 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2459
2460 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2461
2462 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2463 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2464 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2465
2466 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2467 converted.
2468
2469 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2470 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2471 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2472 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2473 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2474 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2475 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002476 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2477 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002478
2479 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2480
2481 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2482 only need this line:
2483
2484 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2485
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002486tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2487 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002488 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002489 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2490 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2491 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2492 being used for too long.
2493
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002494tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2495 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2496 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2497 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2498 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2499 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2500 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2501 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2502 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2503 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2504 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002505 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002506 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002507
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002508tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2509 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2510 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2511 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2512 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002513 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002514 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2515 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002516 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2517 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002518
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002519tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2520 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2521 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2522 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2523 1000 entries.
2524
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002525tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2526 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2527 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2528 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2529
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002530tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002531tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002532tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2533tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2534tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002535 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2536 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2537 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2538 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2539 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2540 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2541 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2542 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002543
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002544 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2545 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2546 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2547 all available space is consumed.
2548 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2549 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2550 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002551
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002552tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2553 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002554 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002555 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002557 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2558
2559tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2560 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2561 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002562 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2563 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025653.3. Debugging
2566--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002568quiet
2569 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2570 line argument "-q".
2571
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002572zero-warning
2573 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2574 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2575 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2576 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2577 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2578 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2579
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025813.4. Userlists
2582--------------
2583It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2584http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2585it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2586
2587userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002588 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002589 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2590
2591group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002592 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002593 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2594 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2595
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002596user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2597 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002598 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2599 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002600 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2601 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2602 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2603 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002604
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002605 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2606 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2607 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2608 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2609 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2610 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2611 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2612 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2613 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002614
2615 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002616 userlist L1
2617 group G1 users tiger,scott
2618 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002619
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002620 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2621 user scott insecure-password elgato
2622 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002623
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002624 userlist L2
2625 group G1
2626 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002627
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002628 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2629 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2630 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002631
2632 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002633
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002634
26353.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002636----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002637It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2638several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2639instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2640values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2641automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2642In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2643using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2644tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2645reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2646Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2647that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2648each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002649
2650peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002651 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002652 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2653
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002654bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2655 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2656 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2657
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002658disabled
2659 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2660 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2661 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2662
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002663default-bind [param*]
2664 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2665
2666default-server [param*]
2667 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2668
2669 Arguments:
2670 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2671 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2672 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2673 details.
2674
2675
2676 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2677
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002678enable
2679 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2680
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002681log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002682 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2683 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2684 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2685 more details.
2686
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002687peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002688 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2689 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002690 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2691 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2692 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2693 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2694 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002695
2696 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2697 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2698
2699 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002700 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2701 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2702 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002703
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002704 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2705 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002706
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002707 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2708 "server" keyword explanation below).
2709
2710server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002711 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002712 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2713 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2714 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2715 of this "peers" section).
2716 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2717
2718
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002719 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002720 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002721 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002722 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2723 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2724 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002725
2726 backend mybackend
2727 mode tcp
2728 balance roundrobin
2729 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2730 stick on src
2731
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002732 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2733 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002734
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002735 Example:
2736 peers mypeers
2737 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2738 default-server ssl verify none
2739 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2740 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002741
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002742
2743table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2744 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2745
2746 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2747 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002748 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002749 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2750 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2751 "stick-table" keyword).
2752
2753 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2754 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2755 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2756 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2757 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2758 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2759 of the stick-table name as follows:
2760
2761 peers mypeers
2762 peer A ...
2763 peer B ...
2764 table t1 ...
2765
2766 frontend fe1
2767 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2768
2769 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2770 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2771
2772 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2773 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2774 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2775 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2776 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2777 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2778 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2779
2780 peers mypeers
2781 peer A ...
2782 peer B ...
2783 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2784
2785 backend t1
2786 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2787
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002788 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002789 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2790 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2791
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027923.6. Mailers
2793------------
2794It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2795If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2796in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2797
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002798mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002799 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2800 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2801
2802mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2803 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2804
2805 Example:
2806 mailers mymailers
2807 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2808 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2809
2810 backend mybackend
2811 mode tcp
2812 balance roundrobin
2813
2814 email-alert mailers mymailers
2815 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2816 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2817
2818 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2819 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2820
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002821timeout mail <time>
2822 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2823 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2824 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2825 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2826
2827 Example:
2828 mailers mymailers
2829 timeout mail 20s
2830 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002831
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028323.7. Programs
2833-------------
2834In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2835master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2836managed the same way as the workers.
2837
2838During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2839sequence as a worker:
2840
2841 - the master is re-executed
2842 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2843 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2844 instance of the program
2845
2846During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2847
2848program <name>
2849 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2850 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2851 the management guide).
2852
2853command <command> [arguments*]
2854 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2855 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2856 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2857 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2858
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002859user <user name>
2860 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2861 See also "group".
2862
2863group <group name>
2864 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2865 See also "user".
2866
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002867option start-on-reload
2868no option start-on-reload
2869 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2870 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2871 program section.
2872
2873
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028743.8. HTTP-errors
2875----------------
2876
2877It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2878imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2879several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2880
2881http-errors <name>
2882 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2883 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2884
2885errorfile <code> <file>
2886 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2887
2888 Arguments :
2889 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002890 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2891 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002892
2893 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2894 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2895 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2896 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2897 before any chroot is performed.
2898
2899 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2900
2901 Example:
2902 http-errors website-1
2903 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2904 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2905 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2906
2907 http-errors website-2
2908 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2909 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2910 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2911
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029123.9. Rings
2913----------
2914
2915It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2916servers or traces.
2917
2918ring <ringname>
2919 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2920
2921description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002922 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002923 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2924
2925format <format>
2926 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2927
2928 Arguments:
2929 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2930 one of the following :
2931
2932 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2933 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2934 designed to be used with a local log server.
2935
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002936 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2937 field is stripped. This is the default.
2938 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2939 rfc3164.
2940
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002941 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2942 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2943 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2944 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2945 is the default.
2946
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002947 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002948 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2949
2950 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2951 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2952
2953 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2954 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2955 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2956 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2957 logger consumes.
2958
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002959 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2960 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2961 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2962 with a local log server.
2963
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002964 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2965 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2966 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2967 used with a local log server.
2968
2969maxlen <length>
2970 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2971 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2972 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2973
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002974server <name> <address> [param*]
2975 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2976 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2977 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2978 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2979 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2980 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2981 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2982 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2983 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002984 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2985 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002986
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002987size <size>
2988 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2989 set to BUFSIZE.
2990
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002991timeout connect <timeout>
2992 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2993
2994 Arguments :
2995 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2996 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2997 as explained at the top of this document.
2998
2999timeout server <timeout>
3000 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3001
3002 Arguments :
3003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3005 as explained at the top of this document.
3006
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003007 Example:
3008 global
3009 log ring@myring local7
3010
3011 ring myring
3012 description "My local buffer"
3013 format rfc3164
3014 maxlen 1200
3015 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003016 timeout connect 5s
3017 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003018 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003019
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030203.10. Log forwarding
3021-------------------
3022
3023It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3024haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3025
3026log-forward <name>
3027 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3028
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003029backlog <conns>
3030 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3031 on connections accept.
3032
3033bind <addr> [param*]
3034 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003035 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3036 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3037 syslog protocol over TCP.
3038 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003039 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3040
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003041dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003042 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3043 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3044 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3045 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003046 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003047
3048log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003049log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003050 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3051 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3052 documentation.
3053 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3054 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3055 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3056 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3057 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3058
3059 Example:
3060 global
3061 log stderr format iso local7
3062
3063 ring myring
3064 description "My local buffer"
3065 format rfc5424
3066 maxlen 1200
3067 size 32764
3068 timeout connect 5s
3069 timeout server 10s
3070 # syslog tcp server
3071 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3072
3073 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003074 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3075 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003076 # all messages on stderr
3077 log global
3078 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3079 log ring@myring local0
3080 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3081 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3082 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3083 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3084 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003085
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003086maxconn <conns>
3087 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3088 10 is the default.
3089
3090timeout client <timeout>
3091 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003094----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003096Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003097 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003098 - frontend <name>
3099 - backend <name>
3100 - listen <name>
3101
3102A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3103its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3104section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003106
3107A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3108connections.
3109
3110A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3111to forward incoming connections.
3112
3113A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3114parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3117'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3118case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3119
3120Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3121logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3122proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3123However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3124name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3125
3126Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3127and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003128bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3130modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3131arbitrary criteria.
3132
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003133In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3134a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003135the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003136
3137 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3138 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3139 between responses and new requests.
3140
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003141 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3142 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3143 client-facing connection remains open.
3144
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003145 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3146 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003147
3148The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3149frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3150following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003151weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003153 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003154
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003155 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3156 ----+-----+-----+----
3157 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3158 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003159 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3160 ----+-----+-----+----
3161 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031654.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3166--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003168The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3169limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3170they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3171limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003172marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003173option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003174and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3175with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3176specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003178
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003179 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3180------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3181acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003182backlog X X X -
3183balance X - X X
3184bind - X X -
3185bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003186capture cookie - X X -
3187capture request header - X X -
3188capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003189clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3190clitcpka-idle X X X -
3191clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003192compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003193cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003194declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003195default-server X - X X
3196default_backend X X X -
3197description - X X X
3198disabled X X X X
3199dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003200email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003201email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003202email-alert mailers X X X X
3203email-alert myhostname X X X X
3204email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003205enabled X X X X
3206errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003207errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003208errorloc X X X X
3209errorloc302 X X X X
3210-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3211errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003212force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003213filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003214fullconn X - X X
3215grace X X X X
3216hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003217http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003218http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003219http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003220http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003221http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003222http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003223http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003224http-check set-var X - X X
3225http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003226http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003227http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003228http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003229http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003230http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003231id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003232ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003233load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003234log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003235log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003236log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003237log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003238max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003239maxconn X X X -
3240mode X X X X
3241monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242monitor-uri X X X -
3243option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3244option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3245option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3246option allbackups (*) X - X X
3247option checkcache (*) X - X X
3248option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3249option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003250option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003251option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3252option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003253-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3254option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003255option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3256option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003257option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003258option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003259option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003260option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003261option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003262option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3263option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3264option httpchk X - X X
3265option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003266option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003267option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003268option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003269option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003270option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003271option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3272option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3273option logasap (*) X X X -
3274option mysql-check X - X X
3275option nolinger (*) X X X X
3276option originalto X X X X
3277option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003278option pgsql-check X - X X
3279option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003280option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003281option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003282option smtpchk X - X X
3283option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3284option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3285option splice-request (*) X X X X
3286option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003287option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003288option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3289option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3290-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003291option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003292option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3293option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3294option tcpka X X X X
3295option tcplog X X X X
3296option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003297external-check command X - X X
3298external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003299persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3300rate-limit sessions X X X -
3301redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003302-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003303retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003304retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003305server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003306server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003307server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003308source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003309srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3310srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3311srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003312stats admin - X X X
3313stats auth X X X X
3314stats enable X X X X
3315stats hide-version X X X X
3316stats http-request - X X X
3317stats realm X X X X
3318stats refresh X X X X
3319stats scope X X X X
3320stats show-desc X X X X
3321stats show-legends X X X X
3322stats show-node X X X X
3323stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003324-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3325stick match - - X X
3326stick on - - X X
3327stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003328stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003329stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003330tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003331tcp-check connect X - X X
3332tcp-check expect X - X X
3333tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003334tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003335tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003336tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003337tcp-check set-var X - X X
3338tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003339tcp-request connection - X X -
3340tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003341tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003342tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003343tcp-response content - - X X
3344tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003345timeout check X - X X
3346timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003347timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003349timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3350timeout http-request X X X X
3351timeout queue X - X X
3352timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003353timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003354timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003355timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003356transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003357unique-id-format X X X -
3358unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003359use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003360use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003361use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003362------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3363 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033664.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3367---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
3369This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3370
3371
3372acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3373 Declare or complete an access list.
3374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3375 no | yes | yes | yes
3376 Example:
3377 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3378 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3379 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003381 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382
3383
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003384backlog <conns>
3385 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | yes | yes | no
3388 Arguments :
3389 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3390 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003391 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003392
3393 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3394 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3395 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3396 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3397 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3398 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3399 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3400 backlog parameter.
3401
3402 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3403 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3404 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3405
3406 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3407
3408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003410balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 yes | no | yes | yes
3414 Arguments :
3415 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3416 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3417 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3418 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3419
3420 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3421 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3422 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3423 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003424 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003425 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003426 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3427 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3428 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3429 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3430 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3431 it, so that you don't worry.
3432
3433 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3434 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3435 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3436 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3437 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3438 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3439 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3440 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003442 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3443 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3444 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3445 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3446 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3447 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3448 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003449 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3450 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3451 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003452
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003453 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003454 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003455 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3456 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003457 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003458 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3459 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3460 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3461 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3462 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003463 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3464 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3465 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3466 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3467 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3468 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3471 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3472 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3473 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3474 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3475 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3476 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3477 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003478 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003480 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3481 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3482 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003483
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003484 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3485 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3486 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3487 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3488 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3489 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3490 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3491 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3492 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3493 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3494 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3495 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003496
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003497 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003498 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3499 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3500 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3501 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3502 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3503 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3504 URIs start with a leading "/".
3505
3506 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3507 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3508 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3509 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3510
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003511 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3512 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3513 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3514 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003516 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003517 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3518
3519 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003520 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3521 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003522 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3523 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3524 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3525 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003526 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003527 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3528 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003529
3530 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3531 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3532 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3533 server will receive the request.
3534
3535 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3536 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3537 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3538 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3539 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003540 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3541 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3542 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003543
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003544 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3545 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3546 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3547 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3548 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003550 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003551 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3552 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3553 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3554
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003555 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3556 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3557 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3558
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003559 random
3560 random(<draws>)
3561 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003562 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3563 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3564 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3565 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003566 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3567 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3568 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3569 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3570 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3571 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3572 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3573 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3574 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3575 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3576 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3577 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3578 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3579 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3580 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3581 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3582 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3583 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3584 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3585 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003586
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003587 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003588 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003589 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3590 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3591 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3592 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3593 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3594 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003595 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003596 used instead.
3597
3598 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3599 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3600 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3601 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3602
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003603 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3604 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3605 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3606
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003607 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003610 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3611 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003612
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003613 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3614 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3615 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003617 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003618 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003619 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3620 NTLM relies on.
3621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622 Examples :
3623 balance roundrobin
3624 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003625 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003626 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3627 balance hdr(host)
3628 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003629
3630 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3631 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003633 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003634 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3635 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3636 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003637 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003638
3639 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3640 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3641 defaults to 16 kB.
3642
3643 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3644 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3645
3646 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3647 Round Robin.
3648
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003649 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003650 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3651 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3652 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3653
3654 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3655
3656 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003657 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003658 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3659 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3660 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003662 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003663
3664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003665bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3666bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3669 no | yes | yes | no
3670 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003671 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3672 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3673 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3674 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003675 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003676 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3677 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3678 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3679 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3680 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3681 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003682 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003683 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3684 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003685 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003686 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3687 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003688 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003689 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3690 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003691 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003692 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3693 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3694 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3695 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3696 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3697 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3698 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003699 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3700 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3701 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003702 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3703 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3704 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3705 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003706 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3707 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3708 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003709
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003710 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3711 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003712 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3713 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3714 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003715 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3716 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3717 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3718 the range.
3719
3720 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3721 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3722 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3723 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3724 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3725 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3726 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003727 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003728 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003729
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003730 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003731 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003732 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3733 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3734 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3735 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3736 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3737 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3738
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003739 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3740 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3741 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3742 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3745 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3746 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3747 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3748 in a frontend.
3749
3750 Example :
3751 listen http_proxy
3752 bind :80,:443
3753 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003754 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003756 listen http_https_proxy
3757 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003758 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003759
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003760 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3761 bind ipv6@:80
3762 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3763 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3764
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003765 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003766 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003767
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003768 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3769 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3770 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3771 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3772 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3773
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003774 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003775 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776
3777
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003778bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003779 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | yes | yes | yes
3782 Arguments :
3783 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3784 may be used to override a default value.
3785
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003786 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003787 option may be combined with other numbers.
3788
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003789 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003790 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3791 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3792 missing from all processes.
3793
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003794 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003795 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003796 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3797 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3798 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3799 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3800 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003801 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003802
3803 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3804 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3805 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3806 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3807 and 'even' instances.
3808
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003809 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3810 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3811 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3812 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003813
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003814 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3815 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3816
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003817 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3818 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3819 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3820
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003821 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3822 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3823
3824 Example :
3825 listen app_ip1
3826 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003827 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003828
3829 listen app_ip2
3830 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003831 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003832
3833 listen management
3834 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003835 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003836
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003837 listen management
3838 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3839 bind-process 1-4
3840
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003841 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003842
3843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003844capture cookie <name> len <length>
3845 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 no | yes | yes | no
3848 Arguments :
3849 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3850 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3851 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3852 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003853 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854
3855 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3856 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3857 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3858 right if it exceeds <length>.
3859
3860 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3861 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3862 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3863 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3864
3865 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3866 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3867 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3868
3869 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3870 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3871 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003872 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3873 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3874 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003875
3876 Example:
3877 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3878
3879 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003880 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003881
3882
3883capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003884 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 no | yes | yes | no
3887 Arguments :
3888 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003889 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003890 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3891 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3892 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3893
3894 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3895 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3896 it exceeds <length>.
3897
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003898 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003899 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3900 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003901 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3902 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3903 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3904 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003905 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003906 environments to find where the request came from.
3907
3908 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3909 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3910 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3911 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003913 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3914 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3915 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3916 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3917 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918
3919 Example:
3920 capture request header Host len 15
3921 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003922 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003924 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003925 about logging.
3926
3927
3928capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003929 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3931 no | yes | yes | no
3932 Arguments :
3933 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003934 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3936 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3937 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3938
3939 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3940 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3941 it exceeds <length>.
3942
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003943 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003944 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3945 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3946 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003947 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3948 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3949 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3950 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003951
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003952 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3953 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3954 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3955 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3956 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003957
3958 Example:
3959 capture response header Content-length len 9
3960 capture response header Location len 15
3961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003962 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003963 about logging.
3964
3965
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003966clitcpka-cnt <count>
3967 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3968 the connection on the client side.
3969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3970 yes | yes | yes | no
3971 Arguments :
3972 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3973
3974 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3975 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003976 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3977 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003978
3979 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3980
3981
3982clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3983 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3984 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3985 client side.
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | yes | yes | no
3988 Arguments :
3989 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3990 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3991 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3992 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3993
3994 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3995 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003996 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3997 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003998
3999 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4000
4001
4002clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4003 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 yes | yes | yes | no
4006 Arguments :
4007 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4008 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4009 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4010 document.
4011
4012 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4013 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004014 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4015 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004016
4017 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4018
4019
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004020compression algo <algorithm> ...
4021compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004022compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004023 Enable HTTP compression.
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | yes | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004027 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4028 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4029 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4030
4031 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004032 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4033 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4034 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004035
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004036 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004037 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004038
4039 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4040 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4041 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4042 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4043 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004044 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004045
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004046 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4047 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4048 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4049 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4050 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4051 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4052 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004053 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004054
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004055 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004056 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004057 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4058 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4059 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4060 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4061 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004062
4063 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4064 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4065 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4066 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4067 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004068 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4069 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4070 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4071 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4072 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004073 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4074 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004075
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004076 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004077 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4078 "Accept-Encoding" header
4079 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004080 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004081 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4082 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4083 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4084 "multipart"
4085 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4086 header
4087 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4088 and later
4089 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4090 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004091 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004092
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004093 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004094
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004095 Examples :
4096 compression algo gzip
4097 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004098
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004099
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004100cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004101 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4102 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004103 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4106 yes | no | yes | yes
4107 Arguments :
4108 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4109 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4110 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4111 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4112 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4113 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004114 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4116 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4117
4118 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4119 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4120 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4121 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4122 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4123 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004124 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4125 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004126 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004127 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4128 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129
4130 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004131 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004132
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004133 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004134 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004135 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004136 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004137 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4138 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4139 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4140 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4141 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4142 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4143 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004144
4145 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4146 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4147 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4148 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4149 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4150 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4151 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4152 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4153 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004154 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004155 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4156 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4157 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004159 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4160 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4161 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004162 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4163 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4164 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4165 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004166 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4167 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4168 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169
4170 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4171 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4172 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4173 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4174 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4175 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4176 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4177 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4178 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4179
4180 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4181 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4182 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4183 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4184 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4185 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4186 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4187 persistence cookie in the cache.
4188 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4189
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004190 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4191 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4192 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4193 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4194 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004195 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004196 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4197 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4198 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4199 they logout.
4200
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004201 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4202 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4203 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4204 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4205
4206 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4207 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4208 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4209 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4210 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4211 this attribute.
4212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004213 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004214 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004215 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4216 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4217 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4218 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4219 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4220 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004221
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004222 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4223 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4224 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4225 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4226 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4227 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4228 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4229 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004230 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004231 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4232 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4233 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4234 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4235 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4236 the site.
4237
4238 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4239 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4240 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4241 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4242 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4243 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4244 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4245 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4246 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4247 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4248 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4249 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4250 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004251 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004252 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4253 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4254
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004255 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4256 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4257 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4258 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4259 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4260 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4261
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004262 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4263 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4264 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4265 repeated.
4266
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4268 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4269 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4270 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272 Examples :
4273 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4274 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4275 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004276 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004278 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004279
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004280
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004281declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4282 Declares a capture slot.
4283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4284 no | yes | yes | no
4285 Arguments:
4286 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4287
4288 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4289 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4290 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4291 for use in the response.
4292
4293 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004294 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004295 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4296
4297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004298default-server [param*]
4299 Change default options for a server in a backend
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | no | yes | yes
4302 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004303 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4304 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4305 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4306 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004307
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004308 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004309 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4310
4311 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004312
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004314default_backend <backend>
4315 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 yes | yes | yes | no
4318 Arguments :
4319 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4320
4321 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4322 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4323 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4324 will catch all undetermined requests.
4325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004326 Example :
4327
4328 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4329 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4330 default_backend dynamic
4331
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004332 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004335description <string>
4336 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4338 no | yes | yes | yes
4339 Arguments : string
4340
4341 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4342 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4343 it describes.
4344 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4345
4346
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004347disabled
4348 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 yes | yes | yes | yes
4351 Arguments : none
4352
4353 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4354 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4355 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4356 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4357 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4358 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4359 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4360
4361 See also : "enabled"
4362
4363
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004364dispatch <address>:<port>
4365 Set a default server address
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004368 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004369
4370 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4371 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4372 during start-up.
4373
4374 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4375 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4376 possible with normal servers.
4377
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004378 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004379 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4380 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4381 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4382 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4383
4384 See also : "server"
4385
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004386
4387dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4388 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4390 yes | no | yes | yes
4391 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4392
4393 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004394 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004395 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4396 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004397 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004398 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004400enabled
4401 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4403 yes | yes | yes | yes
4404 Arguments : none
4405
4406 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4407 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4408
4409 See also : "disabled"
4410
4411
4412errorfile <code> <file>
4413 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4415 yes | yes | yes | yes
4416 Arguments :
4417 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004418 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004419 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004420
4421 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004422 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004424 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4425 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004426
4427 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4428 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4429 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4430
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004431 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4432
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004433 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4434 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4435 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4436 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4437 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4438 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4439 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4440 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4441 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004443 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4444 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4445 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004446 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004447 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4448
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004449 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004450
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004451 Example :
4452 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004453 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004454 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4455 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4456
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004457
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004458errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4459 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4460 section.
4461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4462 yes | yes | yes | yes
4463 Arguments :
4464 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4465
4466 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004467 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004468 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004469
4470 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4471 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4472 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4473 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4474 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004475 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004476 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4477
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004478 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4479 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004480
4481 Example :
4482 errorfiles generic
4483 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4484
4485
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004486errorloc <code> <url>
4487errorloc302 <code> <url>
4488 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 yes | yes | yes | yes
4491 Arguments :
4492 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004493 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004494 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004495
4496 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4497 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4498 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4499 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004500 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004501
4502 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4503 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4504 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4505
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004506 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4507
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004508 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4509 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4510 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4511 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004512 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004513 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4514 request.
4515
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004516 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004517
4518
4519errorloc303 <code> <url>
4520 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | yes
4523 Arguments :
4524 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004525 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004526 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004527
4528 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4529 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4530 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4531 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004532 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004533
4534 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4535 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4536 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4537
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004538 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4539
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004540 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4541 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4542 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4543 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004544 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004545
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004546 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004547
4548
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004549email-alert from <emailaddr>
4550 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004551 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4553 yes | yes | yes | yes
4554
4555 Arguments :
4556
4557 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4558
4559 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4560 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4561
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004562 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004563 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4564 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004565
4566
4567email-alert level <level>
4568 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4569 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 yes | yes | yes | yes
4572
4573 Arguments :
4574
4575 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4576 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4577 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4578
4579 By default level is alert
4580
4581 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4582 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4583 for the proxy.
4584
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004585 Alerts are sent when :
4586
4587 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4588 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4589 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4590 is notice or lower
4591 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4592 and a health check status update occurs
4593
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004594 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4595 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004596 section 3.6 about mailers.
4597
4598
4599email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4600 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4602 yes | yes | yes | yes
4603
4604 Arguments :
4605
4606 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4607
4608 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4609 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4610
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004611 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4612 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004613
4614
4615email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4616 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4617 mailers.
4618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4619 yes | yes | yes | yes
4620
4621 Arguments :
4622
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004623 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004624
4625 By default the systems hostname is used.
4626
4627 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4628 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4629 for the proxy.
4630
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004631 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4632 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004633
4634
4635email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004636 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004637 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4639 yes | yes | yes | yes
4640
4641 Arguments :
4642
4643 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4644
4645 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4646 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4647
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004648 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004649 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4650
4651
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004652force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4653 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004655 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004656
4657 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4658 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4659 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4660 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4661 marked down for maintenance operations.
4662
4663 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4664 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4665 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4666 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4667 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4668 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4669 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4670 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4671 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4672
4673 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4674 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4675 is used.
4676
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004677 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004678 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004679
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004680
4681filter <name> [param*]
4682 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 no | yes | yes | yes
4685 Arguments :
4686 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4687 referenced in section 9.
4688
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004689 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004690 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004691 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4692 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004693
4694 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4695 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4696
4697 Example:
4698 listen
4699 bind *:80
4700
4701 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4702 filter compression
4703 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4704
4705 compression algo gzip
4706 compression offload
4707
4708 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4709
4710 See also : section 9.
4711
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004712
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004713fullconn <conns>
4714 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4716 yes | no | yes | yes
4717 Arguments :
4718 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4719 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4720
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004721 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004722 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004723 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004724 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4725 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4726 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4727 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4728 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004729 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004731 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4732 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004733 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4734 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4735 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737 Example :
4738 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4739 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4740 # connections.
4741 backend dynamic
4742 fullconn 10000
4743 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4744 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4745
4746 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4747
4748
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004749grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004752 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753 Arguments :
4754 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4755 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4756 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4757
4758 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4759 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004760 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004761 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4762
4763 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4764 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4765 simplify it.
4766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004767
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004768hash-balance-factor <factor>
4769 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4771 yes | no | no | yes
4772 Arguments :
4773 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4774 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004775 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004776
4777 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4778 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4779 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4780 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4781 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4782 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4783 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4784
4785 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4786 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4787 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4788 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4789 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4790
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004791 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4792 consistent hashing mechanism.
4793
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004794 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4795
4796
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004797hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004798 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | no | yes | yes
4801 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004802 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4803 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004804
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004805 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4806 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4807 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4808 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4809 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4810 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4811 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4812 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4813 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4814 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004815
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004816 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4817 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4818 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4819 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4820 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4821 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4822 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4823 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4824 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4825 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4826 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4827 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4828 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004829 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4830 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004831
4832 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4833
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004834 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004835 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4836 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4837 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004838 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4839 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4840 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004841
4842 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4843 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004844 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4845 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4846 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4847 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4848
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004849 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4850 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4851 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4852 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4853 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4854 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4855 parameter.
4856
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004857 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4858 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4859 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4860 used on strings.
4861
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004862 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4863
4864 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4865 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4866 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4867 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4868 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4869 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4870 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4871 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4872 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4873 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4874 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4875 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004876
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004877 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4878 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4879 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004880
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004881 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004882
4883
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004884http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4885 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4886 ones).
4887
4888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4889 no | yes | yes | yes
4890
4891 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4892 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4893 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4894 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4895 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4896 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4897
4898 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4899 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4900 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4901
4902 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4903 below.
4904
4905 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4906 instance.
4907
4908 Example:
4909 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4910 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4911 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4912
4913http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4914
4915 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4916 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4917 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4918 example, or to pass some internal information.
4919 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4920 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4921 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4922
4923http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4924
4925 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4926 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4927
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004928http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004929
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004930 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4931 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4932 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4933 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4934 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004935
4936http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4937 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4938
4939 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4940
4941 Example:
4942 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4943
4944 # applied to:
4945 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4946
4947 # outputs:
4948 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4949
4950 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4951
4952http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4953 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4954
4955 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4956
4957 Example:
4958 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4959
4960 # applied to:
4961 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4962
4963 # outputs:
4964 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4965
4966http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4967
4968 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4969 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4970 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4971
4972http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4973 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4974
4975 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4976 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4977 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4978 fallback.
4979
4980 Example:
4981 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4982 http-response set-status 431
4983 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4984 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4985
4986http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4987
4988 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4989 inline.
4990
4991 Arguments:
4992 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4993 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4994 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4995 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4996 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4997 (request and response)
4998 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4999 processing
5000 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5001 processing
5002 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5003 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5004 and '_'.
5005
5006 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5007 followed by some converters.
5008
5009 Example:
5010 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5011
5012http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5013
5014 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5015 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5016 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5017 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5018 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005019 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005020 processing.
5021
5022 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5023 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005024 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005025 rules evaluation.
5026
5027http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5028
5029 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5030 details about <var-name>.
5031
5032 Example:
5033 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5034
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005035
5036http-check comment <string>
5037 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5038 it fails.
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 yes | no | yes | yes
5041
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005042 Arguments :
5043 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5044 rule fails.
5045
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005046 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5047 user-friendly error reporting.
5048
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005049 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005050 "http-check expect".
5051
5052
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005053http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5054 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005055 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005056 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | no | yes | yes
5059
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005060 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005061 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5062
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005063 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005064 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005065
5066 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5067 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5068 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5069 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5070
5071 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5072
5073 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5074
5075 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5076
5077 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5078
5079 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5080
5081 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5082 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5083 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5084 is used.
5085
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005086 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5087 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5088 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5089 haproxy -vv.
5090
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005091 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5092
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005093 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5094 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5095 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5096 different ports or with different servers.
5097
5098 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5099 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5100 the port with a "http-check connect".
5101
5102 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5103 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5104 do.
5105
5106 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5107 unset-var or comment rules.
5108
5109 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005110 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5111 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5112 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5113 option httpchk
5114
5115 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005116 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005117 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005118 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005119 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005120 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005121
5122 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5123
5124 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005125
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005127http-check disable-on-404
5128 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005130 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005131 Arguments : none
5132
5133 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5134 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5135 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5136 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5137 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5138 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5139 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5140 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005141 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5142 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5143 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5144
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005145 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005146
5147
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005148http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005149 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5150 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5151 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005152 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005154 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005155
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005156 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005157 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5158
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005159 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5160 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5161 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5162 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5163 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5164 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5165 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5166 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5167 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5168 result is always conclusive.
5169
5170 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5171 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5172 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005173 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5174 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
5175 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
5176 example 404 with disable-on-404
5177 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5178 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5179 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005180
5181 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5182 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005183 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
5184 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5185 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5186 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5187 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5188 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005189
5190 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5191 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005192 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5193 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5194 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5195 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005196 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5197
5198 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5199 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5200 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5201 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5202
5203 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5204 informational message reported in logs if an error
5205 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5206 log-format string.
5207
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005208 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005209 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5210 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005211 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5212 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5213 details on the supported keywords.
5214
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005215 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5216 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5217 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5218 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005219
5220 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5221 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5222 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5223 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5224 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5225
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005226 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5227 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5228 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5229 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5230 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5231 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5232 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005233
5234 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005235 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005236 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5237 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5238 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5239 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5240
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005241 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5242 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005243 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5244 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5245 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5246 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5247 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5248 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5249 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5250 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005251 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5252 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5253 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5254 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5255 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5256 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5257 insensitive on the header names.
5258
5259 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5260 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5261 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5262 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5263 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5264 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005265
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005266 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005267 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005268 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5269 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5270 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5271 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5272 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005273 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005274 trace).
5275
5276 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005277 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005278 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5279 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5280 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5281 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5282 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005283 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005284
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005285 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5286 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5287 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5288 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5289 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5290 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5291
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005292 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005293 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005294 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5295 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5296 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5297 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5298 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5299 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5300
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005301 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5302 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5303 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5304 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5305 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005306
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005307 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5308 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5309
5310 Examples :
5311 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005312 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005313
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005314 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5315 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5316
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005317 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005318 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005319
5320 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005321 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005322
5323 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005324 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005325
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005326 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005327 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005328
5329
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005330http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005331 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5332 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005333 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5334 health checks.
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | no | yes | yes
5337 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005338 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5339
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005340 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5341 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5342 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5343 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5344 to invent non-standard ones.
5345
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005346 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5347 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5348 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5349 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5350
5351 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5352 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5353 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5354 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005355
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005356 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005357 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005358 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005359 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5360 to add it.
5361
5362 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5363 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5364 to the log-format rules.
5365
5366 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5367 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5368 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005369
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005370 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5371 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5372 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5373 request.
5374
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005375 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5376 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5377 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005378 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5379 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5380 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5381 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelleaea63022020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005382 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005383
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005384 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelleaea63022020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005385 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5386 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005387
5388 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5389 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5390 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5391 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5392 configured request authority.
5393
5394 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5395 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005396
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005397 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005398
5399
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005400http-check send-state
5401 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5403 yes | no | yes | yes
5404 Arguments : none
5405
5406 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5407 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5408 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5409 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5410 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5411
5412 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5413 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5414 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5415 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5416 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005417 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5418 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5419 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5420
5421 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5422 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5423 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5424
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005425 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5426 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5427 checked in multiple backends.
5428
5429 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5430 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5431
5432 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5433 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5434 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5435 one fails.
5436
5437 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5438 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5439 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5440
5441 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5442 server's queue.
5443
5444 Example of a header received by the application server :
5445 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5446 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005448 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5449 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005450
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005451
5452http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 yes | no | yes | yes
5456
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005457 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5459 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5460 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5461 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5462 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5463 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5464 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5465 and '-'.
5466
5467 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5468
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005469 Examples :
5470 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471
5472
5473http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005474 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 yes | no | yes | yes
5477
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005478 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005479 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5480 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5481 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5482 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5483 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5484 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5485 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5486 and '-'.
5487
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005488 Examples :
5489 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005491
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005492http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5493 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5494 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5495 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5496 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5498 yes | yes | yes | yes
5499 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005500 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005501 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005502 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5503 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005504
5505 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5506 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5507 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5508 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5509
5510 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5511 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5512 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5513 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5514
5515 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5516 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5517 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5518 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5519 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5520 chroot is performed.
5521
5522 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5523 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5524 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5525 considered.
5526
5527 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5528 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5529 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5530 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5531 considered as a raw string.
5532
5533 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5534 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5535 "content-type".
5536
5537 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5538 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5539 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5540 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5541 evaluated as a log-format string.
5542
5543 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5544 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5545 argument to "content-type".
5546
5547 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5548 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5549 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5550 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5551
5552 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5553 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5554 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5555 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5556 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5557 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5558 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5559 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5560
5561 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5562 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5563 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5564
5565 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5566 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5567
5568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005569http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005570 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5571
5572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5573 no | yes | yes | yes
5574
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005575 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5576 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5577 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5578 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5579 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5582 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005584 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005586 Example:
5587 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5588 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5589 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005591 http-request allow if nagios
5592 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5593 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5594 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005596 Example:
5597 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5598 acl add path /addacl
5599 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005601 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005603 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5604 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005606 Example:
5607 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5608 acl setmap path /setmap
5609 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005611 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5614 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005616 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5617 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005619http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005621 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5622 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5623 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5624 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5625 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5626 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5627 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5628 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005630http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005632 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5633 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5634 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5635 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5636 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5637 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5638 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5639 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005641http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5644 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005645
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005647http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005649 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5650 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5651 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5652 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5653 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005654
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005655 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5656 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5657 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5658 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5659 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5660 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5661 instead.
5662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005663 Example:
5664 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5665 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005666
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005667http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005668
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005669 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005671http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5672 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005674 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5675 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5676 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5677 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5678 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5679 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5680 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5681 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5682 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005684 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5685 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5686 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005687 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5688
5689 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5690 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5691 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5692 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005694http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005696 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5697 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5698 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5699 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5700 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5701 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005702
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005703http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005704
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005705 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5706 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5707 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5708 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5709 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005711http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005713 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5714 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5715 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5716 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5717 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5718 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005719
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005720http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5721http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5722 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5723 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5724 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5725 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005726
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005727 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5728 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5729 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005730 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005731 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5732 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5733 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005734 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005735 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005736
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005737http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5738 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5739 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5740 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5741
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005742http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5743
5744 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5745 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5746 pointed by <resolvers>.
5747 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5748 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5749 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5750 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5751 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5752 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5753 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5754 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5755 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5756 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5757 to 0.0.0.0.
5758
5759 Example:
5760 resolvers mydns
5761 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5762 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5763 timeout retry 1s
5764 hold valid 10s
5765 hold nx 3s
5766 hold other 3s
5767 hold obsolete 0s
5768 accepted_payload_size 8192
5769
5770 frontend fe
5771 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5772 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5773 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5774
5775 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5776 # which mean DNS resolution error
5777 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5778
5779 default_backend be
5780
5781 backend b_503
5782 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5783 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5784 # 503 error page to end users
5785
5786 backend be
5787 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5788 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5789 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5790 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5791 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5792
5793 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5794 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5795
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005796http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5797
5798 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5799 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5800 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5801 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005802 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5803 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005804
5805 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5810 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5811 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5812 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5813 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005815http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5818 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5819 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5820 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5823 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005824
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005825 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005826 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5827 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5828 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5829 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5830 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005831
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005832 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5833 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5834 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5835 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5836 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005837
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005838 Example:
5839 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5840
5841 # applied to:
5842 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5843
5844 # outputs:
5845 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5846
5847 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005848
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005849 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5850
5851 # applied to:
5852 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005853
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005854 # outputs:
5855 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005856
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005857http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5858 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5859
5860 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5861 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005862 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5863 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5864 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005865
5866 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5867 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5868 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5869
5870 Example:
5871 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5872 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5873
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005874 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5875 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5876 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5877 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5878
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005879http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5880 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5881
5882 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5883 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5884 query-string are replaced.
5885
5886 Example:
5887 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5888 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5889
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005890http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5891 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5892
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005893 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5894 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5895 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5896 against.
5897
5898 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5899 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5900 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005901
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005902 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5903 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5904 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5905 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5906 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5907 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5908 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5909 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5910 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005911 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5912 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005913
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005914 Example:
5915 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5916 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005917
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005918 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5919 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005921http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5922 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005923
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005924 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5925 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5926 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5927 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005928
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005929 Example:
5930 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005931
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005932 # applied to:
5933 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005934
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005935 # outputs:
5936 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005937
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005938http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5939 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5940 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005941 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005942 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5943
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005944 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005945 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5946 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005947 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005948 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005949 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005950 are followed to create the response :
5951
5952 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5953 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5954 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5955 ignored.
5956
5957 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5958 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005959 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005960 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5961 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005962
5963 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5964 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5965 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005966 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005967 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005968
5969 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5970 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5971 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005972 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005973 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5974 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005975
5976 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5977 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5978 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5979 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5980 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5981 as a raw content.
5982
5983 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5984 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5985 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5986 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5987 considered as a raw string.
5988
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005989 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005990 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5991 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5992 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5993
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005994 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5995 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005996 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005997
5998 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5999
6000 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006001 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006002 if { path /ping }
6003
6004 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6005 if { path /favicon.ico }
6006
6007 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6008 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6009 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006011http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6012http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6015 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6016 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006017
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006018http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6019 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006020
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006021 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6022 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6023 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6024 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006028 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6029 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6030 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6031 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6032 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 Arguments:
6035 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6036 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038 Example:
6039 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6040 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6043 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006047 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6048 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6049 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 Arguments:
6052 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6053 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 Example:
6056 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6057 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6060 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6061 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006063http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6066 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6067 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6068 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6069 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 Example:
6072 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6073 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6074 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6075 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6077 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6078 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6079 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6080 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6085 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6086 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6087 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6088 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6091 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6094 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6095 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6096 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6097 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6098 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6099 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6100 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6101 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006103http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006105 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6106 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6107 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6108 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6109 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6110 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6111 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006115 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6116 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6117 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006119http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6122 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6123 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6124 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6125 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6126 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6127 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6128 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006130http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006132 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6133 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6134 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6135 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6136 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6137 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006139 Example :
6140 # prepend the host name before the path
6141 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006142
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006143http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6144
6145 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6146 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6147 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006149http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6152 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6153 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6154 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6155 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006157http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006159 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6160 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6161 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6162 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6163 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6164 values have higher priority.
6165 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6166 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6167 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6168 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6169 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006171http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6174 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6175 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6176 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6177 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6178 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6179 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006181 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006182
6183 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006184 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6185 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006187http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6188 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6189 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6190 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006191 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6192 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006193
6194 Arguments :
6195 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6196 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006197
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006198 See also "option forwardfor".
6199
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006200 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006201 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6202 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6203
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006204 # After the masking this will track connections
6205 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6206 http-request track-sc0 src
6207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006208 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6209 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6210
6211http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6212
6213 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6214 expression.
6215
6216 Arguments:
6217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6218 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006219
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006220 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006221 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6222 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6223
6224 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6225 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6226 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6227
6228http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6229
6230 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6231 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6232 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6233 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6234 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6235 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6236 information from the request.
6237
6238 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6239
6240http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6241
6242 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6243 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6244 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6245 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6246 path and the query string.
6247 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6248
6249http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6250
6251 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6252 inline.
6253
6254 Arguments:
6255 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6256 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6257 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6258 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6259 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6260 (request and response)
6261 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6262 processing
6263 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6264 processing
6265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6266 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6267 and '_'.
6268
6269 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6270 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006271
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006272 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006273 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006275http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6276 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006278 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6279 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6280 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6281 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6282 agent name must be used.
6283
6284 Arguments:
6285 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6286
6287 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6288 configuration.
6289
6290http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6291
6292 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6293 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6294 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6295 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6296 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6297 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6298 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6299 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6300 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6301 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6302 action.
6303 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6304 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6305 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6306 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6307 you fully understand how it works.
6308
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006309http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6310
6311 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6312 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6313 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6314 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6315 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006316 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006317 processing.
6318
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006319 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006320 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6321 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6322 rules evaluation.
6323
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006324http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6325http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6326 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6327 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6328 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6329 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006330
6331 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6332 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6333 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006334 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6335 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6336 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6337 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6338 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6339 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6340 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6341 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6342 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6343 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006344 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006345 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6346 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6347 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6348 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6349 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006350
6351http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6352http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6353http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6354
6355 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6356 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6357 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6358 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006359 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006360 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6361 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6362 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6363 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6364 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6365 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6366 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6367
6368 Arguments :
6369 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6370 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6371 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6372 select which table entry to update the counters.
6373
6374 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6375 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6376 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6377 that table until the session ends.
6378
6379 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6380 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6381 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6382 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6383 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6384 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6385 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6386 useful information.
6387
6388 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6389 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6390 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6391 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6392 checks that make use of it.
6393
6394http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6395
6396 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006397
6398 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006399 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006400
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006401http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6402
6403 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6404 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6405 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6406 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6407 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6408 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6409
6410 Arguments :
6411 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6412
6413 Example:
6414 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006416http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006418 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6419 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6420 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006421
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006423http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006424 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6425
6426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6427 no | yes | yes | yes
6428
6429 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6430 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6431 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6432 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6433 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6434 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006436 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6437 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006439 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006441 Example:
6442 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006446 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6447 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449 Example:
6450 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006452 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006453
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006454 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6455 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006457 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6458 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006460http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006461
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006462 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6463 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6464 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6465 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6466 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6467 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6468 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6469 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006470
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006471http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006472
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006473 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6474 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6475 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6476 example, or to pass some internal information.
6477 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6478 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6479 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006480
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006481http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006482
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006483 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6484 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006485
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006486http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006487
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006488 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006490http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006492 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6493 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6494 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6495 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6496 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6497 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6498 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006500 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6501 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6502 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6503 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6504 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006505
6506 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6507 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6508 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6509 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006510
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006511http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006512
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006513 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6514 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6515 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6516 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6517 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6518 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006519
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006520http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006521
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006522 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6523 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6524 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6525 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6526 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006527
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006528http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006530 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6531 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6532 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6533 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6534 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6535 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006536
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006537http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6538http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6539 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6540 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6541 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006543
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006544 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6545 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6546 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006547 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006548 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6549 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6550 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006551 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006552 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006553
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006554http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006555
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006556 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6557 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6558 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6559 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6560 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6561 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006562
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006563http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6564 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006565
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006566 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6567 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006569 Example:
6570 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006572 # applied to:
6573 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006575 # outputs:
6576 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006577
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006578 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006579
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006580http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6581 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006582
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006583 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006584 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006586 Example:
6587 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006589 # applied to:
6590 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006591
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006592 # outputs:
6593 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006594
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006595http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6596 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6597 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006598 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006599 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6600
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006601 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006602 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6603 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006604 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006605 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006606 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006607 are followed to create the response :
6608
6609 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6610 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6611 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6612 ignored.
6613
6614 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6615 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006616 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006617 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6618 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006619
6620 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6621 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6622 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006623 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006624 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006625
6626 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6627 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6628 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006629 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006630 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6631 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006632
6633 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6634 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6635 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6636 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6637 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6638 as a raw content.
6639
6640 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6641 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6642 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6643 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6644 considered as a raw string.
6645
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006646 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6647 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6648 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6649 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6650
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006651 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6652 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006653 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006654
6655 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6656
6657 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006658 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006659 if { status eq 404 }
6660
6661 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6662 string "This is the end !" \
6663 if { status eq 500 }
6664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006665http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6666http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006667
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006668 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6669 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6670 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006671
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006672http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6673 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006674
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006675 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6676 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6677 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6678 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006679
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006680http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006681
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006682 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6683 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6684 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6685 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6686 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006688 Arguments:
6689 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006690
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006691 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6692 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006693
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006694http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006696 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6697 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6698 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006700http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6701
6702 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6703 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6704 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6705 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6706 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6707
6708http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6709
6710 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6711 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6712 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6713 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6714 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6715 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6716 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6717 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6718 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6719
6720http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6721
6722 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6723 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6724 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6725 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6726 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6727 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6728 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6729
6730http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6731
6732 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6733 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6734 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6735 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6736 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6737 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6738 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6739 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6740
6741http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6742 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6743
6744 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6745 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6746 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6747 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006748
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006749 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006750 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6751 http-response set-status 431
6752 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6753 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006754
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006755http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6758 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6759 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6760 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6761 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6762 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6763 based on some information from the request.
6764
6765 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6766
6767http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6768
6769 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6770 inline.
6771
6772 Arguments:
6773 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6774 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6775 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6776 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6777 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6778 (request and response)
6779 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6780 processing
6781 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6782 processing
6783 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6784 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6785 and '_'.
6786
6787 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6788 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006789
6790 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006791 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006793http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006795 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6796 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6797 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6798 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6799 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6800 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6801 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6802 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6803 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6804 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6805 action.
6806 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6807 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6808 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6809 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6810 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006811
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006812http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6813
6814 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6815 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6816 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6817 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6818 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006819 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006820 processing.
6821
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006822 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006823 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006824 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006825 rules evaluation.
6826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006827http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6828http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6829http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006830
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006831 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6832 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6833 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6834 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6835 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6836 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6837
6838http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6839
6840 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6841 about <var-name>.
6842
6843 Example:
6844 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6845
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006846
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006847http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6848 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6849
6850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6851 yes | no | yes | yes
6852
6853 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006854 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6855 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6856 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006857
6858 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6859
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006860 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6861 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6862 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6863 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6864 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6865 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6866 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6867 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6868 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6869 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006870
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006871 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6872 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6873 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6874 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6875 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6876 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6877 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006878 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6879 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6880 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6881 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6882 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6883 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006884
6885 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6886 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6887 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6888 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6889 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6890 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6891 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6892 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006893 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006894 downsides of rare connection failures.
6895
6896 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6897 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6898 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6899 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6900 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6901 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006902 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006903 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6904 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6905 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6906 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6907 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6908
6909 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006910 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6911 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6912 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006913
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006914 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6915 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6916 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006917
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006918 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6919 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006920
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006921 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006922
6923 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6924 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6925 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6926
6927 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6928
6929
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006930http-send-name-header [<header>]
6931 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006932 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6933 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006934 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006935 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6936
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006937 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6938 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6939 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6940 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6941 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6942 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6943 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6944 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6945 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6946 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6947 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6948 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6949 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6950 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6951 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6952 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006953
6954 See also : "server"
6955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006956id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006957 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6959 no | yes | yes | yes
6960 Arguments : none
6961
6962 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6963 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6964 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006965
6966
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006967ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6968 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006970 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006971
6972 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6973 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6974 and running).
6975
6976 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6977 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6978 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006979 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006980 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6981
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006982 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6983 "unless" condition is met.
6984
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006985 Example:
6986 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6987 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6988 ignore-persist if url_static
6989
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006990 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6991
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006992load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6993 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 yes | no | yes | yes
6996
6997 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6998 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6999 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007000 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007001 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7002 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7003 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7004 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7005
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007006 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007007 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007008 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007009
7010 Arguments:
7011 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7012 named "server-state-file".
7013
7014 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7015 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7016 name is used as a file name.
7017
7018 none don't load any stat for this backend
7019
7020 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007021 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7022 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7023 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007024 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007025 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007026
7027 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7028 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7029
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007030 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007031
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007032 global
7033 stats socket /tmp/socket
7034 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007035
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007036 defaults
7037 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007038
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007039 backend bk
7040 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7041 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007042
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007043
7044 Then one can run :
7045
7046 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7047
7048 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7049
7050 1
7051 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7052 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7053 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7054
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007055 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007056
7057 global
7058 stats socket /tmp/socket
7059 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7060
7061 defaults
7062 load-server-state-from-file local
7063
7064 backend bk
7065 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7066 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7067
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007068
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007069 Then one can run :
7070
7071 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7072
7073 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7074
7075 1
7076 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7077 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7078 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7079
7080 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7081 "show servers state"
7082
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007083
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007084log global
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007085log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007086 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007087no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007088 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007091
7092 Prefix :
7093 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7094 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7095 prefix does not allow arguments.
7096
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007097 Arguments :
7098 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7099 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7100 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7101 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7102 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7103 parameter.
7104
7105 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7106 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7107
7108 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7109 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7110 standard syslog port).
7111
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007112 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7113 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7114 standard syslog port).
7115
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007116 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7117 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7118 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007119 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007120
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007121 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7122 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7123 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7124 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7125 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7126 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7127 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7128 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7129 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7130 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7131 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7132 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7133 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7134 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7135 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7136 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007137 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7138 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007139
7140 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7141 and "fd@2", see above.
7142
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007143 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7144 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7145 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7146 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7147 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7148 having the logs instantly available.
7149
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007150 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7151 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007152
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007153 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7154 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7155 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7156 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7157 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7158 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7159 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7160 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7161 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7162 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007163 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007164
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007165 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7166 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7167 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7168 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7169 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7170
7171 <sample_size>
7172 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7173 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7174 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7175 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7176 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7177
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007178 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7179 one of the following :
7180
Emeric Bruna0338b92020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007181 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7182 field is stripped. This is the default.
7183 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7184 rfc3164.
7185
7186 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007187 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7188
7189 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7190 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7191
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007192 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7193 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7194 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7195 designed to be used with a local log server.
7196
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007197 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7198 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7199 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7200 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7201 systemd logger consumes.
7202
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007203 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7204 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7205 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7206 used with a local log server.
7207
7208 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7209 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7210 designed to be used with a local log server.
7211
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007212 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7213 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7214 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7215 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7216
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007217 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7218
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007219 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7220 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7221 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7222
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007223 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7224 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7225 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7226 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007227
7228 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7229 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7230 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007231 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7232 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7233 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7234 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7235 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007236
7237 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7238
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007239 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7240 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7241 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007242
7243 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7244 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7245 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7246 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7247
7248 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7249 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007250
7251 Example :
7252 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007253 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7254 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7255 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007256 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7257 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007258 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007259
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007260
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007261log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007262 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7263 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7264 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007265
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007266 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7267 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7268 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7269 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7270 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007271
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007272 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7273 "option httplog" directives.
7274
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007275log-format-sd <string>
7276 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7278 yes | yes | yes | no
7279
7280 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7281 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7282 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7283 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7284 which covers the log format string in depth.
7285
7286 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7287 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7288
7289 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7290 log format to "rfc5424".
7291
7292 Example :
7293 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7294
7295
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007296log-tag <string>
7297 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7298 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | yes | yes | yes
7300
7301 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7302 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7303 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7304 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7305 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7306 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7307 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7308 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7309 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007310
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007311max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7312 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7314 yes | no | yes | yes
7315
7316 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7317 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7318 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7319 servers.
7320
7321 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7322 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7323 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7324 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7325 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007326 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007327 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7328 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7329 picking a different server.
7330
7331 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7332 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7333 even if they have to be queued.
7334
7335 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7336 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7337
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007338max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7339 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7340 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7341 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007342
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007343maxconn <conns>
7344 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7346 yes | yes | yes | no
7347 Arguments :
7348 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7349 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7350 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7351 closes.
7352
7353 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7354 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7355 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7356 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007357 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7358 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7359 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7360 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007361
7362 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7363 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7364 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7365
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007366 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7367 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007369 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7370
7371
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007372mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007373 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | yes | yes | yes
7376 Arguments :
7377 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7378 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7379 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7380 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7381
7382 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7383 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7384 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7385 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7386 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7387
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007388 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7389 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7390 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007391
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007392 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007393 defaults http_instances
7394 mode http
7395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007396
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007397monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007398 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007401 Arguments :
7402 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7403 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007404 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007405 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7406 backend and its backup.
7407
7408 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7409 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7410 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7411 servers in a list of backends.
7412
7413 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7414 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7415 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7416 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7417 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7418 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7419 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007420 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7421 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007422
7423 Example:
7424 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007425 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007426 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7427 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7428 monitor-uri /site_alive
7429 monitor fail if site_dead
7430
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007431 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007432
7433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007434monitor-uri <uri>
7435 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7437 yes | yes | yes | no
7438 Arguments :
7439 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7440 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7441
7442 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7443 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7444 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7445 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7446 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7447 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7448 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7449 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7450
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007451 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007452 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7453 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7454 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7455 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7456 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7457 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007458
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007459 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7460 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7461 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7462 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7463
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007464 Example :
7465 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7466 frontend www
7467 mode http
7468 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7469
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007470 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007472
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007473option abortonclose
7474no option abortonclose
7475 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7477 yes | no | yes | yes
7478 Arguments : none
7479
7480 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7481 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7482 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7483 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007484 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007485 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7486 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7487 encountered while delivering the response.
7488
7489 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7490 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7491 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7492 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7493 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7494 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007495 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007496 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007497 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007498 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7499 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7500 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007502 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7503 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007504 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7505 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7506 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7507 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7508 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7509 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007510 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007511
7512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7514
7515 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7516
7517
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007518option accept-invalid-http-request
7519no option accept-invalid-http-request
7520 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7522 yes | yes | yes | no
7523 Arguments : none
7524
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007525 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007526 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007527 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007528 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7529 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7530 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7531 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7532 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007533 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7534 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7535 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7536 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007537 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007538 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007539 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7540 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7541 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007542
7543 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7544 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7545 been confirmed.
7546
7547 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7548 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007549 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7550 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007551 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7552
7553 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7554 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7555
7556 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7557 stats socket.
7558
7559
7560option accept-invalid-http-response
7561no option accept-invalid-http-response
7562 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 yes | no | yes | yes
7565 Arguments : none
7566
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007567 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007568 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007570 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7571 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7572 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7573 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7574 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007575 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7576 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7577 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007578
7579 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7580 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7581 been confirmed.
7582
7583 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7584 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7585 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7586 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7587
7588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7590
7591 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7592 stats socket.
7593
7594
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007595option allbackups
7596no option allbackups
7597 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
7600 Arguments : none
7601
7602 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7603 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7604 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7605 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7606 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7607 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7608 order between the backup servers anymore.
7609
7610 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7611 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7612
7613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7615
7616
7617option checkcache
7618no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007619 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7621 yes | no | yes | yes
7622 Arguments : none
7623
7624 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7625 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007626 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007627 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7628 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007629 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007630
7631 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007632 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007633 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007634 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7635 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007636 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007637 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007638 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7639 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007640 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007641 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7642 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007643 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007644 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7645 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7646 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7647 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7648 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7649 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7650 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7651 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7652 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7653
7654 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007655 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7656 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7657 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7658 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007659
7660 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7661 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007662 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007663 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007664
7665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7667
7668
7669option clitcpka
7670no option clitcpka
7671 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7673 yes | yes | yes | no
7674 Arguments : none
7675
7676 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7677 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007678 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007679 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7680
7681 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7682 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7683 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7684 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7685
7686 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7687 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7688 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7689 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7690 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7691
7692 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7693
7694 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7695 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7696 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7697
7698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7700
7701 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7702
7703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007704option contstats
7705 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 yes | yes | yes | no
7708 Arguments : none
7709
7710 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7711 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7712 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7713 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007714 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7715 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7716 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7717 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7718 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007719
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007720option disable-h2-upgrade
7721no option disable-h2-upgrade
7722 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7723 connection.
7724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7725 yes | yes | yes | no
7726 Arguments : none
7727
7728 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7729 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7730 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7731 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7732 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7733 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7734 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7735 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7736
7737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007739
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007740option dontlog-normal
7741no option dontlog-normal
7742 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 yes | yes | yes | no
7745 Arguments : none
7746
7747 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7748 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7749 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7750 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7751 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7752 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7753 logged.
7754
7755 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7756 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7757 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007759 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007760 logging.
7761
7762
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007763option dontlognull
7764no option dontlognull
7765 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7767 yes | yes | yes | no
7768 Arguments : none
7769
7770 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7771 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7772 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7773 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7774 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7775 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007776 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7777 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7778 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007779
7780 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007781 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007782 would not be logged.
7783
7784 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7785 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7786
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007787 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007788 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007789
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007790
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007791option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007792 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 yes | yes | yes | yes
7795 Arguments :
7796 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7797 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007798 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007799 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007800
7801 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7802 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7803 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7804 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7805 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7806 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7807 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007808 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7809 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7810 possible that the client has already brought one.
7811
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007812 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007813 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007814 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007815 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007816 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007817 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007818
7819 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7820 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7821 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7822 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7823 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7824 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7825 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7826
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007827 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7828 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7829 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7830 are under the control of the end-user.
7831
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007832 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007833 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7834 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007835 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7836 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7837 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007838
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007839 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007840 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7841 frontend www
7842 mode http
7843 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7844
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007845 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7846 backend www
7847 mode http
7848 option forwardfor header X-Client
7849
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007850 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007851 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007852
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007853
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007854option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7855no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7856 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7858 yes | yes | yes | no
7859 Arguments : none
7860
7861 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7862 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7863 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7864 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7865 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7866 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7867 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7868
7869 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7870 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7871 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7872 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7873 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7874 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7875 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7876 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7877 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7878 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7879
7880 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7881
7882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7884
7885 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7886 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7887
7888
7889option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7890no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7891 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7893 yes | no | yes | yes
7894 Arguments : none
7895
7896 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7897 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7898 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7899 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7900 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7901 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7902 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7903
7904 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7905 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7906 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7907 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7908 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7909 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7910 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7911 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7912 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7913 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7914
7915 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7916
7917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7919
7920 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7921 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7922
7923
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007924option http-buffer-request
7925no option http-buffer-request
7926 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 yes | yes | yes | yes
7929 Arguments : none
7930
7931 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7932 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7933 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7934 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7935 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7936 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007937 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7938 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7939 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7940 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007941
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007942 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007943
7944
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007945option http-ignore-probes
7946no option http-ignore-probes
7947 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7949 yes | yes | yes | no
7950 Arguments : none
7951
7952 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7953 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7954 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7955 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7956 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7957 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7958 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7959 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7960 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007961 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7962 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007963 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7964
7965 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7966 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7967 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7968 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7969 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7970 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7971 are often the only way to detect them.
7972
7973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7975
7976 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7977
7978
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007979option http-keep-alive
7980no option http-keep-alive
7981 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7983 yes | yes | yes | yes
7984 Arguments : none
7985
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007986 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7987 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007988 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7989 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007990 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7991 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7992 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007993
7994 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7995 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007996 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7997 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7998 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7999 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8000 situations where this option may be useful :
8001
8002 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008003 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008004
8005 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8006 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8007
8008 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8009 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8010 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8011 request.
8012
8013 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8014 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008015 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8016 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8017 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008018
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008019 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8020 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8021 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8022 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8023 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8024 not set.
8025
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008026 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8027 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8028 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008029
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008030 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008031 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008032 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008033
8034
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008035option http-no-delay
8036no option http-no-delay
8037 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8039 yes | yes | yes | yes
8040 Arguments : none
8041
8042 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8043 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8044 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8045 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8046 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8047 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8048 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8049 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8050 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8051 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8052 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8053 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8054 affected.
8055
8056 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8057 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8058 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8059 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8060 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8061 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8062 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8063 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8064 latency environments.
8065
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008066 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8067
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008068
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008069option http-pretend-keepalive
8070no option http-pretend-keepalive
8071 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008073 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008074 Arguments : none
8075
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008076 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008077 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8078 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8079 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8080 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8081 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8082 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8083 consider the response complete.
8084
8085 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8086 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8087 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8088 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008089 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008090 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8091
8092 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8093 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8094 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8095 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8096 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8097 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8098 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8099
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008100 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8101 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8102 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8103 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8104 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8105 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008106
8107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8109
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008110 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008111 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008112
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008113
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008114option http-server-close
8115no option http-server-close
8116 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 yes | yes | yes | yes
8119 Arguments : none
8120
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008121 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8122 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8123 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8124 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008125 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8126 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8127 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8128 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8129 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8130 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8131 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8132 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8133 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8134 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8135 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008136
8137 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8138 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8139 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8140 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008141 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8142 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008143
8144 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8145 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008146 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8147 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8148 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008149
8150 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8151 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008153 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8154 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008155
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008156option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008157no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008158 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 yes | yes | yes | no
8161 Arguments : none
8162
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008163 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008164 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8165 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8166 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8167 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8168 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8169 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8170
8171 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8172 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008173 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8174 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8175 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008176
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008177 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8178 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8179 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8180 front of an existing proxy.
8181
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008182 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8183
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008184 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008186option httpchk
8187option httpchk <uri>
8188option httpchk <method> <uri>
8189option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008190 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 yes | no | yes | yes
8193 Arguments :
8194 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8195 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8196 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8197 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8198 ones.
8199
8200 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8201 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8202 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8203
8204 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8205 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8206 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008207 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008208
8209 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8210 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8211 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8212 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8213 the lack of any response.
8214
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008215 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8216 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8217 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8218 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8219
8220 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8221 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8222 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008223
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008224 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8225 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008226 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008227 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008228 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008229
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008230 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8231 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8232 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8233 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8234
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008235 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008236 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8237 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8238 backend https_relay
8239 mode tcp
8240 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8241 http-check send hdr Host www
8242 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008243
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008244 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8245 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8246 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008247
8248
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008249option httpclose
8250no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008251 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8253 yes | yes | yes | yes
8254 Arguments : none
8255
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008256 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8257 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8258 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8259 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008260 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008261
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008262 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8263 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008264 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008265 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8266 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008267
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008268 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8269 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8270 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008271
8272 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8273 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008274 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8275 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8276 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008277
8278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8280
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008281 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008282
8283
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008284option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008285 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008287 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008288 Arguments :
8289 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8290 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8291 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008292 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008293 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008294
8295 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8296 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8297 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8298 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8299 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8300 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8301 ports.
8302
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008303 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8304 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008305
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008306 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008308 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008309
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008310
8311option http_proxy
8312no option http_proxy
8313 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 yes | yes | yes | yes
8316 Arguments : none
8317
8318 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8319 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8320 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8321 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8322 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8323
8324 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8325 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008326 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8327 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008328
8329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8331
8332 Example :
8333 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8334 backend direct_forward
8335 option httpclose
8336 option http_proxy
8337
8338 See also : "option httpclose"
8339
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008340
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008341option independent-streams
8342no option independent-streams
8343 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | yes | yes | yes
8346 Arguments : none
8347
8348 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8349 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8350 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8351 receive data or not.
8352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008353 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008354 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8355 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8356 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8357 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8358 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8359 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8360 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8361 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8362 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8363 socket buffers.
8364
8365 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8366 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8367 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8368 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8369 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8370
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008371 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008372
8373
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008374option ldap-check
8375 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8377 yes | no | yes | yes
8378 Arguments : none
8379
8380 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8381 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8382 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8383 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8384
8385 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8386 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8387
8388 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8389 configure it.
8390
8391 Example :
8392 option ldap-check
8393
8394 See also : "option httpchk"
8395
8396
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008397option external-check
8398 Use external processes for server health checks
8399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8400 yes | no | yes | yes
8401
8402 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8403 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8404 command".
8405
8406 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8407
8408 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8409
8410
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008411option log-health-checks
8412no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008413 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8415 yes | no | yes | yes
8416 Arguments : none
8417
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008418 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8419 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8420 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008421
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008422 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8423 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8424 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8425 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8426 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8427
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008428 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008429 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008430
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008431 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8432 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8433 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008434
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008435
8436option log-separate-errors
8437no option log-separate-errors
8438 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | yes | yes | no
8441 Arguments : none
8442
8443 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8444 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8445 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8446 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8447 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8448 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8449 provides very important information.
8450
8451 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8452 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8453 error logs.
8454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008455 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008456 logging.
8457
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008458
8459option logasap
8460no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008461 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8463 yes | yes | yes | no
8464 Arguments : none
8465
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008466 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8467 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8468 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8469 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8470
8471 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8472 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8473 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8474 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8475 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008476 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008477 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8478 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8479 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8480 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008481 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008483 Examples :
8484 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8485 mode http
8486 option httplog
8487 option logasap
8488 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8489
8490 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8491 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8492 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8493 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008495 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008496 logging.
8497
8498
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008499option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008500 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8502 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008503 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008504 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8505 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008506 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8507 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008508
8509 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8510 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008511 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008512 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8513 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8514 in the MySQL table, like this :
8515
8516 USE mysql;
8517 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8518 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8519
8520 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008521 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008522 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8523 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8524 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8525 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8526 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8527 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8528 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8529
8530 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8531 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008532
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008533 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008534
8535 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8536 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8537 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8538 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008539 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8540 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008541
8542 See also: "option httpchk"
8543
8544
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008545option nolinger
8546no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008547 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8549 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008550 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008552 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008553 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8554 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8555 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8556 connections.
8557
8558 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8559 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008560 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8561 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8562 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8563 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8564 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8565 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8566 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8567 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8568 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8569 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8570 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8571 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8572 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008573
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008574 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8575 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8576 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8577 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8578 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008579
8580 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8581 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008582 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8583 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8584 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008585
8586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8588
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008589 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8590 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008591
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008592option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8593 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8595 yes | yes | yes | yes
8596 Arguments :
8597 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8598 matching <network>
8599 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8600 header name.
8601
8602 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8603 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8604 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8605 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8606 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8607 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8608 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8609 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8610 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8611 possible that the client has already brought one.
8612
8613 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8614 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8615 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8616 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8617 header and requires different one.
8618
8619 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8620 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8621 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8622 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8623 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8624 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8625 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8626
8627 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8628 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8629 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8630 both are defined.
8631
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008632 Examples :
8633 # Original Destination address
8634 frontend www
8635 mode http
8636 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8637
8638 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8639 backend www
8640 mode http
8641 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8642
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008643 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008644
8645
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008646option persist
8647no option persist
8648 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8650 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008651 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008652
8653 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8654 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8655 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8656 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8657 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8658 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8659 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8660 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8661 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8662 redirected to another valid server.
8663
8664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8666
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008667 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008668
8669
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008670option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8671 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 yes | no | yes | yes
8674 Arguments :
8675 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8676 PostgreSQL server.
8677
8678 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8679 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8680 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8681 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8682
8683 See also: "option httpchk"
8684
8685
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008686option prefer-last-server
8687no option prefer-last-server
8688 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8690 yes | no | yes | yes
8691 Arguments : none
8692
8693 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8694 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8695 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8696 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8697 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8698 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8699 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8700 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8701 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008702 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8703 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008704 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8705 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8706 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008707 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8708 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8709 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008710
8711 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8712 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8713
8714 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8715
8716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008717option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008718option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008719no option redispatch
8720 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8722 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008723 Arguments :
8724 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8725 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8726 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008727 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008728 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008729 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008730 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8731 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8732 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008734
8735 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8736 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8737 be able to access the service anymore.
8738
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008739 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8740 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008741
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008742 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8743 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8744 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8745 following order:
8746
8747 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8748
8749 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8750 list, or
8751
8752 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8753
8754 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8755 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8756
8757 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8758 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8759 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8760 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8761
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008762 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008763 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8764 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8768
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008769 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008770
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008771
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008772option redis-check
8773 Use redis health checks for server testing
8774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8775 yes | no | yes | yes
8776 Arguments : none
8777
8778 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8779 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8780 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8781 find the "+PONG" response message.
8782
8783 Example :
8784 option redis-check
8785
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008786 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008787
8788
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008789option smtpchk
8790option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8791 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8793 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008795 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008796 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008797 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8798
8799 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8800 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8801 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8802
8803 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8804 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8805 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8806 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8807 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8808 dead server.
8809
8810 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8811 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008812 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008813 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8814
8815 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8816 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8817 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8818 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008819 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008820
8821 Example :
8822 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8823
8824 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008827option socket-stats
8828no option socket-stats
8829
8830 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | no
8833
8834 Arguments : none
8835
8836
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008837option splice-auto
8838no option splice-auto
8839 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8841 yes | yes | yes | yes
8842 Arguments : none
8843
8844 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8845 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008846 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008847 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008848 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008849 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8850 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8851 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8852 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8853
8854 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8855 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8856 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8857 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8858 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8859 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8860 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8861 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8862 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8863 keyword.
8864
8865 Example :
8866 option splice-auto
8867
8868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8870
8871 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8872 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8873
8874
8875option splice-request
8876no option splice-request
8877 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8879 yes | yes | yes | yes
8880 Arguments : none
8881
8882 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008883 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008884 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8885 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8886 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8887 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8888
8889 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8890
8891 Example :
8892 option splice-request
8893
8894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8896
8897 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8898 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8899
8900
8901option splice-response
8902no option splice-response
8903 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8905 yes | yes | yes | yes
8906 Arguments : none
8907
8908 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008909 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008910 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8911 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8912 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8913 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8914
8915 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8916
8917 Example :
8918 option splice-response
8919
8920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8922
8923 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8924 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8925
8926
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008927option spop-check
8928 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8930 no | no | no | yes
8931 Arguments : none
8932
8933 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8934 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8935 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8936 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8937
8938 Example :
8939 option spop-check
8940
8941 See also : "option httpchk"
8942
8943
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008944option srvtcpka
8945no option srvtcpka
8946 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8948 yes | no | yes | yes
8949 Arguments : none
8950
8951 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8952 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008953 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008954 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8955
8956 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8957 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8958 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8959 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8960
8961 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8962 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8963 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8964 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8965 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8966
8967 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8968
8969 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8970 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8971 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8972
8973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8975
8976 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8977
8978
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008979option ssl-hello-chk
8980 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | no | yes | yes
8983 Arguments : none
8984
8985 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8986 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8987 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8988 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8989 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8990 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8991 hello message.
8992
8993 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8994 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8995 messages, which is appreciable.
8996
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008997 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8998 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8999 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009000
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009001 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9002
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009003
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009004option tcp-check
9005 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | no | yes | yes
9008
9009 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9010 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9011
9012 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9013 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9014 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9015
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009016 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009017 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9018 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9019 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9020 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9021 only.
9022
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009023 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009024 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9025 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9026 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9027 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9028
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009029 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9031 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009032 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009033 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9034 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9035 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9036 the respective protocols.
9037 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009038 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009039
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009040 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009042 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9043 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9044 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9045 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009046
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009047 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9048 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9049 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009050
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009051
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009052 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009053 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009054 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009055 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009056
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009057 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009058 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009059 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009060
9061 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9062 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009063 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009064 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009065 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009066 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009067 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009068 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009069 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9070 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009071 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009072 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9073 tcp-check expect string +OK
9074
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009075 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009076 (send many headers before analyzing)
9077 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009078 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009079 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9080 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9081 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9082 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009083 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009084
9085
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009086 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009087
9088
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009089option tcp-smart-accept
9090no option tcp-smart-accept
9091 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9093 yes | yes | yes | no
9094 Arguments : none
9095
9096 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9097 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9098 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9099 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9100 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9101 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9102
9103 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9104 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9105 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9106 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9107
9108 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9109 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9110 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009111 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009112
9113 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9114 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9115 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9116
9117 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9118 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9119 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9120
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009121 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9122
9123
9124option tcp-smart-connect
9125no option tcp-smart-connect
9126 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9128 yes | no | yes | yes
9129 Arguments : none
9130
9131 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9132 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9133 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9134 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9135 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9136
9137 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9138 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9139 complex.
9140
9141 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9142 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9143 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9144
9145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9147
9148 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9149
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009150
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009151option tcpka
9152 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | yes | yes | yes
9155 Arguments : none
9156
9157 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9158 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009159 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009160 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9161
9162 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9163 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9164 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9165 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9166
9167 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9168 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9169 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9170 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9171 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9172
9173 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9174
9175 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9176 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9177 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9178 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9179 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9180 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9181 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9182 backends.
9183
9184 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9185
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009186
9187option tcplog
9188 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009190 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009191 Arguments : none
9192
9193 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9194 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9195 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9196 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9197 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9198 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9199 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9200 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9201
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009202 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009204 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009205
9206
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009207option transparent
9208no option transparent
9209 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009211 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009212 Arguments : none
9213
9214 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9215 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9216 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9217 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9218 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9219 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9220 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9221 appropriate server.
9222
9223 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9224 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9225
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009226 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009227 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009228
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009229
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009230external-check command <command>
9231 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 yes | no | yes | yes
9234
9235 Arguments :
9236 <command> is the external command to run
9237
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009238 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9239
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009240 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009241
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009242 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9243 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9244 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9245 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9246 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9247 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009248
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009249 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9250
9251 Environment variables :
9252 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9253 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9254
9255 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9256
9257 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9258
9259 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9260 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9261 for a UNIX socket).
9262
9263 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9264
9265 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9266
9267 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9268
9269 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9270
9271 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9272
9273 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9274 socket).
9275
9276 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9277 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9278
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009279 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9280
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009281 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9282 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9283 failed.
9284
9285 Example :
9286 external-check command /bin/true
9287
9288 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9289
9290
9291external-check path <path>
9292 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9294 yes | no | yes | yes
9295
9296 Arguments :
9297 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9298
9299 The default path is "".
9300
9301 Example :
9302 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9303
9304 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9305 "external-check command"
9306
9307
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009308persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009309persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009310 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9312 yes | no | yes | yes
9313 Arguments :
9314 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009315 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9316 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009317
9318 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9319 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009320 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009321 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9322 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9323 forwarded to this server.
9324
9325 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9326 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9327 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009328 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009329 a single "listen" section.
9330
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009331 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9332 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9333 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9334
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009335 Example :
9336 listen tse-farm
9337 bind :3389
9338 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9339 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9340 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9341 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9342 persist rdp-cookie
9343 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009344 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009345 balance rdp-cookie
9346 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9347 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9348
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009349 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9350 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009351
9352
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009353rate-limit sessions <rate>
9354 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9356 yes | yes | yes | no
9357 Arguments :
9358 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9359 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9360
9361 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9362 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9363 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9364 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9365 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9366 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9367
9368 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9369 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9370 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9371 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9372
9373 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9374 listen smtp
9375 mode tcp
9376 bind :25
9377 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009378 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009379
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009380 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9381 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9382 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009383
9384 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9385
9386
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009387redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9388redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9389redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009390 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9392 no | yes | yes | yes
9393
9394 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009395 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009396
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009397 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009398 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009399 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9400 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9401 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009402
9403 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9404 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9405 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9406 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9407 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009408 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9409 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9410 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9411 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009412
9413 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9414 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9415 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9416 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9417 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9418 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009419 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009420 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009421 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9422 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9423 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009424
9425 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009426 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9427 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9428 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009429 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009430 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9431 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9432 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9433 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009434
9435 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009436 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009437
9438 - "drop-query"
9439 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9440 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9441 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9442 with a location-type redirect.
9443
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009444 - "append-slash"
9445 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9446 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9447 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9448 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9449
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009450 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9451 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9452 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9453 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9454 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9455 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9456 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9457
9458 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9459 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9460 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9461 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9462 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9463 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9464 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009465
9466 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9467 acl clear dst_port 80
9468 acl secure dst_port 8080
9469 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009470 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009471 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009472 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9473
9474 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009475 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9476 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9477 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009478 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009479
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009480 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9481 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9482 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9483
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009484 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009485 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009486
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009487 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009488 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9489 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9490 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009492 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009494
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009495retries <value>
9496 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9498 yes | no | yes | yes
9499 Arguments :
9500 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9501 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9502 default value is 3.
9503
9504 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9505 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9506 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9507
9508 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009509 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9510 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009511
9512 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9513 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9514
9515 See also : "option redispatch"
9516
9517
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009518retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009519 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9520 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9521 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009522 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9523 yes | no | yes | yes
9524 Arguments :
9525 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9526 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9527 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9528 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9529
9530 none never retry
9531
9532 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9533 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9534
9535 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9536 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9537 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9538 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9539 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9540 processing the request.
9541
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009542 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9543 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9544 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9545 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9546 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9547 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9548 overflow attack for example).
9549
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009550 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9551 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9552 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9553 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9554 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9555 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9556 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9557 amplify denial of service attacks.
9558
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009559 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9560 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9561 considered to be safe to retry.
9562
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009563 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9564 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9565 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9566 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9567
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009568 all-retryable-errors
9569 retry request for any error that are considered
9570 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9571 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9572 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9573
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009574 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9575 not cumulative.
9576
9577 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9578 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9579 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9580 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9581
9582 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9583 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9584 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9585 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9586 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9587 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9588 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9589 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9590 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9591 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9592 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9593 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9594
9595 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9596 should not use this directive.
9597
9598 The default is "conn-failure".
9599
9600 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9601
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009602server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009603 Declare a server in a backend
9604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9605 no | no | yes | yes
9606 Arguments :
9607 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009608 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009609 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009610
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009611 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9612 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9613 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9614 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009615 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9616 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9617 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9618 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9619 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009620 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9621 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9622 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9623 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9624 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9625 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9626 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009627 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009628 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9629 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9630 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9631 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9632 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9633 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009634 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9635 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009636 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9637 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009638
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009639 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009640 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9641 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9642 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9643 adding this value to the client's port.
9644
9645 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9646 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009647 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009648
9649 Examples :
9650 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9651 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009652 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009653 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9654 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9655 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009656
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009657 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9658 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9659 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9660 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9661 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9662
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009663 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9664 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009665
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009666server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009667 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009668 this backend.
9669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9670 no | no | yes | yes
9671
9672 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9673 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9674 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9675 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9676 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009677
9678 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9679 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9680
9681 global
9682 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9683
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009684 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009685 load-server-state-from-file
9686
Christopher Faulet05df94b2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009687 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009688 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009689
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009690server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9691 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9692 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9694 no | no | yes | yes
9695
9696 Arguments:
9697 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9698
9699 <num | range>
9700 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9701 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9702 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9703 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9704
9705 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9706
9707 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9708
9709 <params*>
9710 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9711 keyword.
9712
9713 Examples:
9714 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9715 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9716 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9717
9718 # or
9719 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9720
9721 # would be equivalent to:
9722 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9723 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9724 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9725
9726
9727
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009728source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009729source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009730source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009731 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9733 yes | no | yes | yes
9734 Arguments :
9735 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9736 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009738 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009739 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9740 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9741 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9742 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9743 supported prefixes are :
9744 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9745 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9746 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009747 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009748 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9749 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009750
9751 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9752 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009753 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9754 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9755 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009756
9757 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9758 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9759 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9760 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9761 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9762 <addr>.
9763
9764 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9765 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9766 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9767 port.
9768
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009769 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9770 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9771 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9772 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009773 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009774 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9775 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9776 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9777 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9778 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9779 HTTP header.
9780
9781 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9782 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009783 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009784 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9785 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9786 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9787 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9788 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9789 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9790 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9791
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009792 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9793 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9794 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9795 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9796 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9797 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9798
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009799 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9800 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9801 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9802 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9803
9804 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9805 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9806 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9807 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9808 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9809 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9810
9811 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9812 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9813 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9814 there are two methods :
9815
9816 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9817 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9818 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9819 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9820 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9821 of the client ranges may be used.
9822
9823 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9824 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9825 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9826 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9827 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9828 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9829 same session.
9830
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009831 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9832 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9833 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009834 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009835
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009836 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9837
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009838 Examples :
9839 backend private
9840 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9841 source 192.168.1.200
9842
9843 backend transparent_ssl1
9844 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9845 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9846
9847 backend transparent_ssl2
9848 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9849 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9850 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9851
9852 backend transparent_ssl3
9853 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9854 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9855 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9856
9857 backend transparent_smtp
9858 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9859 # with Tproxy version 4.
9860 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9861
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009862 backend transparent_http
9863 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9864 # proxy.
9865 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009867 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009868 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9869
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009870
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009871srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9872 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9873 the connection on the server side.
9874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9875 yes | no | yes | yes
9876 Arguments :
9877 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9878
9879 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9880 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009881 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9882 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009883
9884 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9885
9886
9887srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9888 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9889 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9890 server side.
9891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9892 yes | no | yes | yes
9893 Arguments :
9894 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9895 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9896 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9897 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9898
9899 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9900 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009901 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9902 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009903
9904 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9905
9906
9907srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9908 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | no | yes | yes
9911 Arguments :
9912 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9913 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9914 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9915 document.
9916
9917 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9918 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009919 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9920 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009921
9922 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9923
9924
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009925stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9926 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009928 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009929
9930 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9931 matched.
9932
9933 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9934 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9935
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009936 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9937 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009938 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009939
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009940 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9941 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9942 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9943 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009944
9945 Example :
9946 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9947 backend stats_localhost
9948 stats enable
9949 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9950
9951 Example :
9952 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9953 backend stats_auth
9954 stats enable
9955 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9956 stats admin if TRUE
9957
9958 Example :
9959 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9960 userlist stats-auth
9961 group admin users admin
9962 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9963 group readonly users haproxy
9964 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9965
9966 backend stats_auth
9967 stats enable
9968 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9969 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9970 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9971 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9972
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009973 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9974 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9975 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009976
9977
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009978stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9979 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009981 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009982 Arguments :
9983 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9984
9985 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9986
9987 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9988 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9989 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9990 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9991 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9992 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9993
9994 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9995 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9996 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009997 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009998
9999 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10000 report using "stats scope".
10001
10002 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10003 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10004 unobvious parameters.
10005
10006 Example :
10007 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10008 backend public_www
10009 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10010 stats enable
10011 stats hide-version
10012 stats scope .
10013 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010014 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010015 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10016 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10017
10018 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10019 backend private_monitoring
10020 stats enable
10021 stats uri /admin?stats
10022 stats refresh 5s
10023
10024 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10025
10026
10027stats enable
10028 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010030 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010031 Arguments : none
10032
10033 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10034 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10035 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10036 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10037 - stats auth : no authentication
10038 - stats scope : no restriction
10039
10040 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10041 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10042 unobvious parameters.
10043
10044 Example :
10045 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10046 backend public_www
10047 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10048 stats enable
10049 stats hide-version
10050 stats scope .
10051 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010052 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010053 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10054 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10055
10056 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10057 backend private_monitoring
10058 stats enable
10059 stats uri /admin?stats
10060 stats refresh 5s
10061
10062 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10063
10064
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010065stats hide-version
10066 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010068 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010069 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010071 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10072 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10073 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10074 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10075 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10076 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010078 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10079 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10080 unobvious parameters.
10081
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010082 Example :
10083 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10084 backend public_www
10085 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010086 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087 stats hide-version
10088 stats scope .
10089 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010090 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010091 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10092 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010093
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010094 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10095 backend private_monitoring
10096 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010097 stats uri /admin?stats
10098 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010099
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010100 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010101
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010102
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010103stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10104 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10105 Access control for statistics
10106
10107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10108 no | no | yes | yes
10109
10110 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10111 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10112 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10113 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10114 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10115 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10116
10117 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10118 instance.
10119
10120 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10121 about ACL usage.
10122
10123
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010124stats realm <realm>
10125 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010127 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010128 Arguments :
10129 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10130 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10131 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10132
10133 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10134 using a backslash ('\').
10135
10136 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10137 only related to authentication.
10138
10139 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10140 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10141 unobvious parameters.
10142
10143 Example :
10144 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10145 backend public_www
10146 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10147 stats enable
10148 stats hide-version
10149 stats scope .
10150 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010151 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010152 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10153 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10154
10155 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10156 backend private_monitoring
10157 stats enable
10158 stats uri /admin?stats
10159 stats refresh 5s
10160
10161 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10162
10163
10164stats refresh <delay>
10165 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010167 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010168 Arguments :
10169 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10170 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10171 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10172 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10173 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10174 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10175
10176 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10177 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10178 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010179 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010180
10181 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10182 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10183 unobvious parameters.
10184
10185 Example :
10186 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10187 backend public_www
10188 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10189 stats enable
10190 stats hide-version
10191 stats scope .
10192 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010193 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010194 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10195 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10196
10197 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10198 backend private_monitoring
10199 stats enable
10200 stats uri /admin?stats
10201 stats refresh 5s
10202
10203 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10204
10205
10206stats scope { <name> | "." }
10207 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010209 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010210 Arguments :
10211 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10212 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10213 section in which the statement appears.
10214
10215 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10216 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10217 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10218 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10219 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10220 exists.
10221
10222 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10223 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10224 unobvious parameters.
10225
10226 Example :
10227 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10228 backend public_www
10229 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10230 stats enable
10231 stats hide-version
10232 stats scope .
10233 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010234 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010235 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10236 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10237
10238 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10239 backend private_monitoring
10240 stats enable
10241 stats uri /admin?stats
10242 stats refresh 5s
10243
10244 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010246
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010247stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010248 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010250 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010251
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010252 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010253 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10254
10255 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10256 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10257
10258 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10259 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010260 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010261
10262 Example :
10263 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10264 backend private_monitoring
10265 stats enable
10266 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10267 stats uri /admin?stats
10268 stats refresh 5s
10269
10270 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10271 global section.
10272
10273
10274stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010275 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10277 yes | yes | yes | yes
10278 Arguments : none
10279
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010280 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010281 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10282 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10283 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10284 - IP (socket, server)
10285 - cookie (backend, server)
10286
10287 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10288 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010289 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010290
10291 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10292
10293
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010294stats show-modules
10295 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 yes | yes | yes | yes
10298 Arguments : none
10299
10300 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10301 values as a tooltip.
10302
10303 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10304 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10305 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10306
10307 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10308
10309
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010310stats show-node [ <name> ]
10311 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010313 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010314 Arguments:
10315 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10316 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10317
10318 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10319 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010320 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010321
10322 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10323 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10324 unobvious parameters.
10325
10326 Example:
10327 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10328 backend private_monitoring
10329 stats enable
10330 stats show-node Europe-1
10331 stats uri /admin?stats
10332 stats refresh 5s
10333
10334 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10335 section.
10336
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010337
10338stats uri <prefix>
10339 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010341 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010342 Arguments :
10343 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10344 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10345 query string.
10346
10347 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10348 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10349 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10350 possible to reach it in the application.
10351
10352 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010353 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010354 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10355 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10356 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10357 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10358
10359 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10360 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10361 an address or a port to statistics only.
10362
10363 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10364 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10365 unobvious parameters.
10366
10367 Example :
10368 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10369 backend public_www
10370 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10371 stats enable
10372 stats hide-version
10373 stats scope .
10374 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010375 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010376 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10377 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10378
10379 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10380 backend private_monitoring
10381 stats enable
10382 stats uri /admin?stats
10383 stats refresh 5s
10384
10385 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10386
10387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010388stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10389 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010391 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010392
10393 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010394 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010395 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010396 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010397 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10398
10399 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10400 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10401 the "stick-table" statement.
10402
10403 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10404 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10405 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10406 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10407 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10408
10409 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10410 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10411 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10412 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10413 transformation rules.
10414
10415 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10416 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10417 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10418 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10419 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10420 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10421 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10422
10423 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10424 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10425 ACL based conditions.
10426
10427 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10428 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10429 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10430 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10431
10432 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10433 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10434 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10435 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10436
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010437 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10438 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010439 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010440
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010441 Example :
10442 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10443 # last 30 minutes
10444 backend pop
10445 mode tcp
10446 balance roundrobin
10447 stick store-request src
10448 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10449 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10450 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10451
10452 backend smtp
10453 mode tcp
10454 balance roundrobin
10455 stick match src table pop
10456 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10457 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10458
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010459 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010460 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010461
10462
10463stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10464 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10466 no | no | yes | yes
10467
10468 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10469 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10470 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10471 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10472
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010473 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10474 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010475 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010476
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010477 Examples :
10478 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010479 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010480
10481 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10482 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10483 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10484
10485
10486 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10487 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10488 backend http
10489 mode http
10490 balance roundrobin
10491 stick on src table https
10492 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10493 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10494 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10495
10496 backend https
10497 mode tcp
10498 balance roundrobin
10499 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10500 stick on src
10501 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10502 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10503
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010504 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010505
10506
10507stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10508 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10510 no | no | yes | yes
10511
10512 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010513 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010514 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010515 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010516 server is selected.
10517
10518 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10519 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10520 the "stick-table" statement.
10521
10522 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10523 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10524 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10525 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10526 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10527 address.
10528
10529 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10530 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10531 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10532 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10533 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10534 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10535 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10536 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10537 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10538 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10539
10540 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10541 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10542 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10543 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10544 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10545 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10546 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10547
10548 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10549 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10550 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10551 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10552
10553 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10554 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10555 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10556 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10557 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10558 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010559 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10560 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10561 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10562 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10563 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10564 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010565
10566 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10567 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10568 the request.
10569
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010570 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10571 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010573
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010574 Example :
10575 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10576 # last 30 minutes
10577 backend pop
10578 mode tcp
10579 balance roundrobin
10580 stick store-request src
10581 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10582 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10583 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10584
10585 backend smtp
10586 mode tcp
10587 balance roundrobin
10588 stick match src table pop
10589 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10590 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10591
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010592 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010593 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010594
10595
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010596stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010597 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10598 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010599 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010601 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010602
10603 Arguments :
10604 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10605 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10606 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10607 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10608
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010609 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10610 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10611 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10612 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10613
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010614 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10615 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10616 instance.
10617
10618 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10619 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10620 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10621 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10622 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10623 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010624 to 32 characters.
10625
10626 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10627 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10628 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010629 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010630 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10631 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010632
10633 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010634 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10635 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010636 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10637 increase.
10638
10639 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010640 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10641 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10642 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010643
10644 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10645 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10646 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10647 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010649 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10650 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10651 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10652 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10653 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10654 parameter (see below).
10655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010656 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10657 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10658 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10659 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10660 soft restart.
10661
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010662 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10663 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010664
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010665 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10666 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10667 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10668 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010669 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010670 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010671 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10672 if not expiration delay is specified.
10673
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010674 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10675 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10676 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10677 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010678 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10679 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10680 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10681 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10682 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10683 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10684 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10685 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10686 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10687 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10688 types and their arguments.
10689
10690 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10691 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10692 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10693 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10694
10695 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10696 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10697 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010698 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010699
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010700 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10701 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10702 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010703 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010704 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010705 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010706
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010707 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10708 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10709 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10710 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10711
10712 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10713 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10714 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10715 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10716 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10717 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10718
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010719 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10720 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10721 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10722 they were received.
10723
10724 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10725 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10726 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10727 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10728 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10729
10730 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10731 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10732 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10733 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10734 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10735
10736 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10737 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10738 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10739
10740 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10741 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10742 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10743 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10744 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10745
10746 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10747 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10748 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10749 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10750 the client side.
10751
10752 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10753 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10754 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10755 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10756 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10757 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10758 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10759
10760 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10761 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10762 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10763 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10764 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10765 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010766 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010767
10768 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10769 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10770 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10771 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10772 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10773 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10774
10775 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010776 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010777 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10778 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10779
10780 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10783 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10784 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10785 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10786 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10787 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10788 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10789 recommended for better fairness.
10790
10791 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010793 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10794 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10795
10796 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10797 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10799 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10800 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10801 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10802 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10803 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10804 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10805 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010806
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010807 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10808 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010809 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10810 reference it.
10811
10812 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10813 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010814 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10815 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10816 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010817
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010818 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10819 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10820 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10821 something that can be ignored.
10822
10823 Example:
10824 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10825 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10826 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10827 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10828
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010829 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010830 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010831
10832
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010833stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010834 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10836 no | no | yes | yes
10837
10838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010839 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010840 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010841 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010842 server is selected.
10843
10844 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10845 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10846 the "stick-table" statement.
10847
10848 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10849 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10850 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10851 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10852
10853 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10854 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10855 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10856 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10857 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10858 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010859 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010860 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10861 rules.
10862
10863 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10864 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10865 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10866 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10867 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10868 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10869 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10870
10871 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10872 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10873 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10874 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10875
10876 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10877 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10878 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10879 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10880 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10881 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010882 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10883 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10884 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10885 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10886 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10887 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10888 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10889 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10890 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010891
10892 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10893
10894 Example :
10895 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10896 backend https
10897 mode tcp
10898 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010899 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010900 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010901
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010902 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10903 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10904
10905 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10906 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10907 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10908
10909 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10910 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010911
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010912 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10913 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10914 # at offset 44.
10915
10916 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10917 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10918
10919 # Learn on response if server hello.
10920 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010921
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010922 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10923 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10924
10925 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10926 extraction.
10927
10928
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010929tcp-check comment <string>
10930 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10931 it fails.
10932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10933 yes | no | yes | yes
10934
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010935 Arguments :
10936 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10937 rule fails.
10938
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010939 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10940 user-friendly error reporting.
10941
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010942 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10943 "tcp-check expect".
10944
10945
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010946tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10947 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010948 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010949 Opens a new connection
10950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010951 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010952
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010953 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010954 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10955
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010956 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010957 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010958
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010959 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010960 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10961 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010962 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010963
10964 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010965
10966 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10967
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010968 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10969
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010970 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10971
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010972 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10973
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010974 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10975 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10976 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10977 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10978
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010979 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10980 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10981 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10982 haproxy -vv.
10983
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010984 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010985
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010986 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10987 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10988 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10989
10990 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10991 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10992 of the sequence.
10993
10994 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10995 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10996 do.
10997
10998 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10999 unset-var or comment rules.
11000
11001 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011002 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11003 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11004 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11005 option tcp-check
11006 tcp-check connect
11007 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11008 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11009 tcp-check send \r\n
11010 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11011 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11012 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11013 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11014 tcp-check send \r\n
11015 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11016 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11017
11018 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11019 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011020 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011021 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11022 tcp-check connect port 143
11023 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11024 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11025
11026 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11027
11028
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011029tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011030 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011031 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011032 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011033 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011035 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011036
11037 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011038 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11039
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011040 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11041 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11042 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11043 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11044 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11045 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11046 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11047 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11048 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11049 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11050
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011051 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011052 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11053 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011054 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11055 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11056 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11057
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011058 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11059 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11060 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011061 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11062 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
11063 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
11064 example 404 with disable-on-404
11065 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11066 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011067 By default "L7OK" is used.
11068
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011069 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11070 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011071 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
11072 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11073 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11074 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11075 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11076 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011077
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011078 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011079 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011080 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11081 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11082 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11083 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011084 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11085
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011086 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11087 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11088 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11089 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11090
11091 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11092 informational message reported in logs if an error
11093 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11094 log-format string.
11095
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011096 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11097 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11098 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11099 followed by some converters.
11100
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011101 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11102 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11103 with the usual backslash ('\').
11104 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011106 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11107 used upper or lower case.
11108
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011109 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11110
11111 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11112 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11113 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11114 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11115 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11116 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11117 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11118 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11119
11120 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11121 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11122 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11123 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11124 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11125 expression.
11126
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011127 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11128 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11129 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11130 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11131 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11132 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11133
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011134 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11135 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11136 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11137 this exact hexadecimal string.
11138 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11139
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011140 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11141 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11142 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11143 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11144 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11145 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11146 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11147 size.
11148
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011149 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11150 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11151 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11152 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11153 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11154 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11155 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11156 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11157 in a binary string before matching the response's
11158 buffer.
11159
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011160 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011161 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011162 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11163 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11164 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11165 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11166 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11167 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11168 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11169 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11170 the null character.
11171
11172 Examples :
11173 # perform a POP check
11174 option tcp-check
11175 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11176
11177 # perform an IMAP check
11178 option tcp-check
11179 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11180
11181 # look for the redis master server
11182 option tcp-check
11183 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011184 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011185 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11186 tcp-check expect string role:master
11187 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11188 tcp-check expect string +OK
11189
11190
11191 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011192 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011193
11194
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011195tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11196tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11197 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11198 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011200 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011201
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011202 Arguments :
11203 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11204
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011205 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11206 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011207
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011208 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11209 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011210
11211 Examples :
11212 # look for the redis master server
11213 option tcp-check
11214 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11215 tcp-check expect string role:master
11216
11217 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011218 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011219
11220
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011221tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11222tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11223 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11224 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011226 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011227
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011228 Arguments :
11229 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011230
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011231 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11232 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011233
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011234 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11235 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11236 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011237
11238 Examples :
11239 # redis check in binary
11240 option tcp-check
11241 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11242 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11243
11244
11245 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Faulet7151a122020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011246 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011247
11248
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011249tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011250 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011252 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011253
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011254 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011255 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11256 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11257 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11258 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11259 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11260 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11261 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11262 and '-'.
11263
11264 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11265
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011266 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011267 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11268
11269
11270tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011271 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011273 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011274
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011275 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011276 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11277 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11278 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11279 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11280 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11281 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11282 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11283 and '-'.
11284
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011285 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011286 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11287
11288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011289tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11290 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11292 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011294 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11295 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011296
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011297 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011298
11299 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11300 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011301 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11302 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11303 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11304 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11305 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11306 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011308 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11309 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11310 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11311 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011312
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011313 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011314 - accept :
11315 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11316 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11317 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011318
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011319 - reject :
11320 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11321 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11322 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11323 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11324 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11325 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11326 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11327 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11328 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11329 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11330 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011331 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011332
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011333 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11334 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11335 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11336 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11337 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11338 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11339 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11340 hosts.
11341
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011342 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11343 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11344 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11345 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11346 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11347 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11348 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11349 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11350
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011351 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11352 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11353 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11354 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11355 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11356 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11357 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11358 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11359 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011360 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11361 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011362
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011363 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011364 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011365 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11366 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11367 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011368 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011369 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011370 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11371 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11372 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11373 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11374 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11375 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11376 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011378 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011379 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011380 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011381 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011382 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11383 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11384 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011385
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011386 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11387 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11388 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11389 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011391 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11392 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11393 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11394 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11395 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011396 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11397 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11398 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11399 layer7 information is extracted.
11400
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011401 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11402 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11403 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11404 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11405 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011406
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011407 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11408 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11409 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11410 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11411
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011412 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11413 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11414 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11415 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11416
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011417 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11418 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11419 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11420 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11421 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011422
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011423 - set-src <expr> :
11424 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11425 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11426 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011427 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011429 Arguments:
11430 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11431 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011432
11433 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011434 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11435
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011436 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11437 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011438
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011439 - set-src-port <expr> :
11440 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11441 expression.
11442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011443 Arguments:
11444 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11445 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011446
11447 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011448 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11449
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011450 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11451 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11452 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011453
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011454 - set-dst <expr> :
11455 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11456 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11457 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11458 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11459 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11460
11461 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11462 followed by some converters.
11463
11464 Example:
11465
11466 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11467 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11468
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011469 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11470 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11471
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011472 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11473 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11474 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11475 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11476
11477
11478 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11479 followed by some converters.
11480
11481 Example:
11482
11483 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11484
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011485 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11486 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11487 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11488
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011489 - "silent-drop" :
11490 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011491 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011492 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11493 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11494 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11495 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11496 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011497 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11498 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011499 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11500 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011501 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011502 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11503 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11504 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11505 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011507 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11508 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11509 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011511 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11512 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11513 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011514
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011515 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011516 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011517 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011519 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11520 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11521 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011523 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011524 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11525 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011526
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011527 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11528
11529 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11530
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011531 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11532
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011533 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011534
11535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011536tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11537 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011539 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011540 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011541 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11542 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011544 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011545
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011546 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011547 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11548 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11549 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11550 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011551
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011552 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11553 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11554 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11555 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011556 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11557 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11558 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11559 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11560 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11561 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011562 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011563 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011564
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011565 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11566 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11567 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11568 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011569
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011570 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011571 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011572 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011573 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11574 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011575 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011576 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011577 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011578 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011579 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011580 - set-dst <expr>
11581 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011582 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011583 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011584 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011585 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011586 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011587
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011588 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11589 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011590 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11591 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011592
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011593 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11594 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11595 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11596 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11597 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11598 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011600 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011601 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11602 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011603
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011604 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11605 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11606 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11607 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11608 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11609 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11610
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011611 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011612 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11613 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11614 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11615 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11616 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11617 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11618 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11619 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11620 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11621 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011622
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011623 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011624 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11625 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11626 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011627
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011628 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11629 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11630
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011631 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011632 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11633 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011634
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011635 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11636 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011637 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011638 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11639 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011640 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011642 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11644 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011646 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11647 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011648
11649 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11650 followed by some converters.
11651
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011652 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11653 <var-name>.
11654
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011655 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11656 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11657 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11658 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11659 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11660
11661 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11662 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11663 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11664 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11665 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11666 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11667 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11668 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11669 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11670 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11671 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11672
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011673 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11674 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11675 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11676 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11677 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11678
11679 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11680
11681 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11682
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011683 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11684 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11685 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11686 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11687 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11688 evaluated.
11689
11690 Example:
11691 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11692
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011693 Example:
11694
11695 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011696 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011697
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011698 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011699 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11700 # and reject everything else.
11701 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11702 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011703 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011704 tcp-request content reject
11705
11706 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011707 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11708 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11709 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011710 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011711
11712 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11713 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11714 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011715 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011716 tcp-request content reject
11717
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011718 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011719 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011720 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011721 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011722 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11723 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011724
11725 Example:
11726 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11727 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011728 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011729
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011730 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011731 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011732
11733 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011734 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011735 # protecting all our sites
11736 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011737 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11738 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011739 ...
11740 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11741
11742 backend http_dynamic
11743 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011744 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011745 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011746 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011747 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011748 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011749 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011751 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011752
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011753 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11754 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011755
11756
11757tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11758 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011760 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011761 Arguments :
11762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11764 as explained at the top of this document.
11765
11766 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11767 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11768 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11769 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11770 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11771
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011772 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11773 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11774 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11775 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11776
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011777 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11778 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011779 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011780 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011781 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11782 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11783 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11784 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011785
11786 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11787 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11788 it pass through unaffected.
11789
11790 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11791 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11792 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011793 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011794 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11795 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011796 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11797 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11798 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011799
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011800 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011801 "timeout client".
11802
11803
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011804tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11805 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11807 no | no | yes | yes
11808 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011809 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11810 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011811
11812 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11813
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011814 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011815 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11816 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011817 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11818 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011819
11820 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11821
11822 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11823 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11824 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11825 inserted.
11826
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011827 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011828 - accept :
11829 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11830 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11831 the rules evaluation.
11832
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011833 - close :
11834 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11835 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11836 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11837 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11838 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11839 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011840 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011841 protocols.
11842
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011843 - reject :
11844 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11845 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011846 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011847
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011848 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11849 Sets a variable.
11850
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011851 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11852 Unsets a variable.
11853
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011854 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11855 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11856 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11857 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11858
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011859 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11860 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11861 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11862 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11863
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011864 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11865 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11866 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11867 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11868 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011869
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011870 - "silent-drop" :
11871 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011872 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011873 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11874 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11875 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11876 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11877 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011878 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11879 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011880 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11881 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011882 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011883 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11884 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11885 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11886 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11887
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011888 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11889 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11890
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011891 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11892 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11893 for changing the default action to a reject.
11894
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011895 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11896 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11897 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11898 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011899 period.
11900
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011901 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11902 declared inline.
11903
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011904 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11905 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011906 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011907 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11908 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011909 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011910 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011911 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011912 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11913 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011914 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011915 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11916 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011917
11918 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11919 followed by some converters.
11920
11921 Example:
11922
11923 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11924
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011925 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11926 <var-name>.
11927
11928 Example:
11929
11930 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11931
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011932 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11933 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11934 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11935 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11936 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11937
11938 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11939
11940 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11941
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011942 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11943
11944 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11945
11946
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011947tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11948 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11950 no | yes | yes | no
11951 Arguments :
11952 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11953 below.
11954
11955 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11956
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011957 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011958 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11959 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11960 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11961 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11962 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11963 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11964 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011965 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011966 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11967 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11968 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11969 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11970 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11971 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11972 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11973 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11974 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11975 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11976 instead.
11977
11978 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11979 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11980 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11981 rules which may be inserted.
11982
11983 Several types of actions are supported :
11984 - accept : the request is accepted
11985 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11986 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11987 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011988 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011989 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011990 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011991 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011992 - silent-drop
11993
11994 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11995 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11996 sections for a complete description.
11997
11998 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11999 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12000 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12001
12002 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12003 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12004 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12005 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12006 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12007
12008 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12009 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12010
12011 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12012 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12013 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12014
12015 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12016 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12017 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12018
12019 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12020 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12021 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12022
12023 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12024 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12025 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12026
12027 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12028
12029 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12030
12031
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012032tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12033 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12035 no | no | yes | yes
12036 Arguments :
12037 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12038 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12039 as explained at the top of this document.
12040
12041 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12042
12043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012044timeout check <timeout>
12045 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12046 established.
12047
12048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12049 yes | no | yes | yes
12050 Arguments:
12051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12053 as explained at the top of this document.
12054
12055 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12056 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012057 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012058 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012059 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12060 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12061 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012062
12063 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12064 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12065
12066 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12067 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012068 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012069
12070 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12071 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12072 forget about it.
12073
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012074 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12075 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012076
12077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012078timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012079 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12081 yes | yes | yes | no
12082 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12085 as explained at the top of this document.
12086
12087 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12088 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12089 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012090 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12091 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12092 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12093 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012094 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12095 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12096 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012097 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012098 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012099 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12100 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012101 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12102 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012103
12104 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12105 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12106 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12107 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012108 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012109 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12110
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012111 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012112
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012113 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012115
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012116timeout client-fin <timeout>
12117 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12119 yes | yes | yes | no
12120 Arguments :
12121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12123 as explained at the top of this document.
12124
12125 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12126 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12127 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12128 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12129 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12130 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12131 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012132 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12133 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12134 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012135
12136 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12137 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12138 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12139
12140 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12141
12142
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012143timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012144 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12146 yes | no | yes | yes
12147 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12150 as explained at the top of this document.
12151
12152 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012153 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012154 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012155 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012156 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12157 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012158
12159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12161 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12162 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012163 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012164 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12165
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012166 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012168
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012169timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12170 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12172 yes | yes | yes | yes
12173 Arguments :
12174 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12175 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12176 as explained at the top of this document.
12177
12178 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12179 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12180 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12181 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12182 once the request has started to present itself.
12183
12184 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12185 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12186 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12187 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12188 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12189
12190 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12191 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12192 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12193 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12194
12195 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12196 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012197 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012198 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12199 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012200 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012201
12202 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12203 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12204 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12205 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12206
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012207 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12208 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012209 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12210
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012211 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12212
12213
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012214timeout http-request <timeout>
12215 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012217 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12221 as explained at the top of this document.
12222
12223 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12224 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12225 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12226 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12227 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12228 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12229 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012230 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12231 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12232 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12233 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012235 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12236 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012237
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012238 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12239 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12240 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12241 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12242 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012243 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012244
12245 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12246 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012247 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012248 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12249 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12250
12251 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012252 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12253 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12254 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012255
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012256 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012257 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012258
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012259
12260timeout queue <timeout>
12261 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12263 yes | no | yes | yes
12264 Arguments :
12265 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12266 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12267 as explained at the top of this document.
12268
12269 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12270 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12271 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12272 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12273 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12274
12275 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12276 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12277 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12278 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12279
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012280 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012281
12282
12283timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012284 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12286 yes | no | yes | yes
12287 Arguments :
12288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12290 as explained at the top of this document.
12291
12292 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12293 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12294 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12295 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12296 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12297 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12298 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12299
12300 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12301 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12302 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12303 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12304 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012305 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012306 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012307 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12308 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012309 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12310 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012311
12312 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12313 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12314 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12315 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012316 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012317 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12318
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012319 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012320
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012321
12322timeout server-fin <timeout>
12323 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12325 yes | no | yes | yes
12326 Arguments :
12327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12329 as explained at the top of this document.
12330
12331 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12332 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12333 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12334 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12335 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12336 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12337 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12338 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12339 situations, it should not be needed.
12340
12341 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12342 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12343 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12344
12345 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12346
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012347
12348timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012349 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12351 yes | yes | yes | yes
12352 Arguments :
12353 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12354 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12355 as explained at the top of this document.
12356
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012357 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12358 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12359 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012360
12361 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12362 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12363 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12364 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012365 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012366
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012367 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012368
12369
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012370timeout tunnel <timeout>
12371 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12373 yes | no | yes | yes
12374 Arguments :
12375 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12376 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12377 as explained at the top of this document.
12378
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012379 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012380 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12381 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12382 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012383 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12384 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012385 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12386 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12387 specified.
12388
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012389 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12390 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12391 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12392 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12393 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12394 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12395 state.
12396
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012397 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12398 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12399 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12400 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012401 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012402
12403 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12404 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12405 forget about it.
12406
12407 Example :
12408 defaults http
12409 option http-server-close
12410 timeout connect 5s
12411 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012412 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012413 timeout server 30s
12414 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12415
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012416 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012417
12418
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012419transparent (deprecated)
12420 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012422 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012423 Arguments : none
12424
12425 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12426 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12427 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12428 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12429 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12430 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12431 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12432 appropriate server.
12433
12434 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12435
12436 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12437 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12438
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012439 See also: "option transparent"
12440
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012441unique-id-format <string>
12442 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12444 yes | yes | yes | no
12445 Arguments :
12446 <string> is a log-format string.
12447
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012448 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12449 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12450 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12451 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012452
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012453 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12454 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12455 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12456 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12457 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12458 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12459 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12460 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012461
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012462 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12463 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012464
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012465 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012466
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012467 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012468
12469 will generate:
12470
12471 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12472
12473 See also: "unique-id-header"
12474
12475unique-id-header <name>
12476 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12478 yes | yes | yes | no
12479 Arguments :
12480 <name> is the name of the header.
12481
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012482 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12483 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012484
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012485 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012486
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012487 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012488 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12489
12490 will generate:
12491
12492 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12493
12494 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012495
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012496use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012497 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12499 no | yes | yes | no
12500 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012501 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12502 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012503
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012504 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12505 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012506
12507 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12508 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12509 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012510 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012511 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012512 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12513 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012514
12515 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12516 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12517 assign the backend.
12518
12519 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12520 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12521 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12522 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12523 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12524 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12525
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012526 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012527 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012528 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12529 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12530 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12531
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012532 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12533 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12534 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12535 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12536 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12537 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12538 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12539 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12540 cannot be forced from the request.
12541
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012542 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012543 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12544 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12545
12546 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12547 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012548
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012549use-fcgi-app <name>
12550 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12552 no | no | yes | yes
12553 Arguments :
12554 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12555
12556 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012557
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012558use-server <server> if <condition>
12559use-server <server> unless <condition>
12560 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12562 no | no | yes | yes
12563 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012564 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12565 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012566
12567 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12568
12569 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12570 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12571 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12572
12573 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12574 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12575 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12576 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12577 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12578 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12579 matches will assign the server.
12580
12581 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12582 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12583 with the next rules until one matches.
12584
12585 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12586 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12587 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12588 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12589
12590 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12591 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12592 stripped.
12593
12594 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12595 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012596 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12597 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12598 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012599
12600 Example :
12601 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12602 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12603 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12604 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012605 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012606 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012607 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012608 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12609 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12610
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012611 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12612 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12613 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12614 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012615 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012616 and we fall back to load balancing.
12617
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012618 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012619
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012620
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126215. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012622--------------------------
12623
12624The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12625depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12626settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12627written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12628described in this section.
12629
12630
126315.1. Bind options
12632-----------------
12633
12634The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12635as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12636no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12637parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12638while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12639provided immediately after the setting name.
12640
12641The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12642
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012643accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12644 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12645 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12646 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12647 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12648 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12649 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12650 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12651 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12652 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012653 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12654 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12655 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012656
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012657accept-proxy
12658 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012659 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12660 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012661 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12662 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12663 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12664 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012665 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012666 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12667 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012668 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12669 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012670
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012671allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012672 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012673 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012674 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012675 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12676 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012677
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012678alpn <protocols>
12679 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12680 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12681 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012682 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012683 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012684 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12685 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12686 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12687 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12688 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12689 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12690 preference, like below :
12691
12692 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012694backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012695 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012696 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12697
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012698curves <curves>
12699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12700 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12701 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12702 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12703 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12704 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12705
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012706ecdhe <named curve>
12707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012708 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12709 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012710
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012711ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12713 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12714 client's certificate.
12715
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012716ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12718 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12719 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12720 error is ignored.
12721
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012722ca-sign-file <cafile>
12723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12724 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12725 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12726 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12727 'generate-certificates' for details.
12728
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012729ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12731 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12732 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12733 'generate-certificates' for details.
12734
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012735ca-verify-file <cafile>
12736 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12737 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12738 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12739 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12740 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012742ciphers <ciphers>
12743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12744 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012745 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012746 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012747 information and recommendations see e.g.
12748 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12749 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12750 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12751
12752ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12754 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12755 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12756 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012757 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12758 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012759
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012760crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12762 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12763 to verify client's certificate.
12764
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012765crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12767 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12768 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12769 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12770 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012771 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12772 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012773
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012774 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12775 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12776
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012777 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12778 are loaded.
12779
12780 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012781 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12782 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12783 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12784 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12785 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12786 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12787 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012788 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012789
12790 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12791 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12792 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12793 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012794 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12795 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012796
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012797 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012799 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012800 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012801 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12802 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012803 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12804 clients).
12805
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012806 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12807 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12808 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12809 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12810 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12811 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12812 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12813 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12814 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12815 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12816 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12817 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12818 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12819
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012820 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12821 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12822 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12823 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12824 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12825
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012826 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12827 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12828 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12829 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012830
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012831 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12832 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12833 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012834
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012835crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012837 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012838 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012839 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012840
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012841crt-list <file>
12842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012843 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12844 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012845
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012846 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12847
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012848 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12849 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12850 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12851 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12852 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012853
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012854 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012855 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12856 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12857 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12858 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12859 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012860 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12861 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12862 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012863
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012864 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12865 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12866 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012867
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012868 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12869
Joao Morais5ae6bfc2020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012870 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12871 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12872 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12873 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12874 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12875 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12876 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12877 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012878
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012879 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012880 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012881 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012882 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012883 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012884 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012885
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012886defer-accept
12887 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12888 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12889 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012890 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012891 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12892 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12893 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12894 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12895 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12896 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12897 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12898
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012899expose-fd listeners
12900 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12901 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012902 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12903 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012904 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012905
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012906force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012907 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012908 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012909 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012910 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012911
12912force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012913 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012914 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012915 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012916
12917force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012918 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012919 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012920 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012921
12922force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012923 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012924 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012925 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012926
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012927force-tlsv13
12928 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12929 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012930 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012931
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012932generate-certificates
12933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12934 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12935 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12936 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12937 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12938 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12939 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12940 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12941 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12942 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12943 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12944
12945 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12946 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012947 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012948 certificate is used many times.
12949
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012950gid <gid>
12951 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12952 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12953 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12954 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12955 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12956
12957group <group>
12958 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12959 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12960 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12961 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12962 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12963
12964id <id>
12965 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12966 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12967 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12968 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12969
12970interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012971 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12972 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12973 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12974 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12975 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12976 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012977 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12978 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12979 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12980 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12981 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12982 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012983
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012984level <level>
12985 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12986 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12987 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012988 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012989 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12990 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12991 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012992 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012993 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012994 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012995 all counters).
12996
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012997severity-output <format>
12998 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12999 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13000 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13001 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13002 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13003 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13004 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13005 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13006 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13007 rfc5424 convention.
13008
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013009maxconn <maxconn>
13010 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13011 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13012 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13013 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13014 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13015 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13016 eat all memory.
13017
13018mode <mode>
13019 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13020 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13021 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13022 UNIX sockets.
13023
13024mss <maxseg>
13025 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13026 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13027 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13028 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13029 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13030 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13031 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13032 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13033 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13034 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13035 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13036
13037name <name>
13038 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13039 page.
13040
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013041namespace <name>
13042 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13043 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13044 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13045 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13046
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013047nice <nice>
13048 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13049 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13050 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13051 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13052 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13053 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13054 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13055 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13056 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13057 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13058 one for an RDP socket.
13059
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013060no-ca-names
13061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13062 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013063 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013064
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013065no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013067 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013068 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013069 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013070 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13071 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013072
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013073no-tls-tickets
13074 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13075 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13076 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013077 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13078 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013079 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13080 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13081 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013082
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013083no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013085 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013086 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013087 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013088 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13089 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013090
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013091no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013093 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013094 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013095 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013096 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13097 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013098
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013099no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013100 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013101 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013102 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013103 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013104 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13105 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013106
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013107no-tlsv13
13108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13109 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13110 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13111 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013112 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13113 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013114
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013115npn <protocols>
13116 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13117 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13118 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013119 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013120 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013121 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13122 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13123 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13124 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13125 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013126
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013127prefer-client-ciphers
13128 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13129 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13130 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013131 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13132 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13133 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013134
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013135process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013136 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013137 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013138 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013139 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13140 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13141 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13142 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013143 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013144 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13145 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13146 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13147 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13148 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013149
13150 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13151
13152 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13153 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13154 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13155 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13156 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13157 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13158 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13159 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013160
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013161proto <name>
13162 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13163 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13164 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13165 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013166 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013167 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013168 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013169 h2" on the bind line.
13170
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013171ssl
13172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013173 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013174 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13175 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013176 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13177 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013178
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013179ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13180 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013181 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13182 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13183 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013184 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13185
13186ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013187 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13188 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13189 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13190 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013191
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013192strict-sni
13193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13194 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13195 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13196 See the "crt" option for more information.
13197
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013198tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013199 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013200 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13201 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013202 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013203 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13204 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13205 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13206 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13207 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13208 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13209 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13210
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013211tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013212 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013213 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13214 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13215 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13216 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13217 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13218 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13219 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013220 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13221 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13222 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013223
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013224tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13225 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013226 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13227 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13228 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13229 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13230 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13231 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13232 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13233 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13234 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13235 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013236 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13237 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013239transparent
13240 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13241 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13242 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13243 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13244 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13245 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13246 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13247 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13248 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13249 so check for support with your vendor.
13250
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013251v4v6
13252 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13253 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13254 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13255 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013256 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013257
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013258v6only
13259 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13260 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13261 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013262 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13263 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013265uid <uid>
13266 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13267 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13268 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13269 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13270 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13271
13272user <user>
13273 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13274 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13275 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13276 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13277 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13278
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013279verify [none|optional|required]
13280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13281 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13282 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13283 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13284 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013285 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13286 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13287 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13288 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013291------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013293The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13294which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13295arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13296settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13297after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13298Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13299address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013301 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013302 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013303
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013304Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13305keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013307The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013308
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013309addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013310 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013311 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13312 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13313 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13314 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13315 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013316
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013317agent-check
13318 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013319 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013320 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13321 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13322 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013323
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013324 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013325 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013326 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13327 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13328 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013329
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013330 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13331 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13332 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13333 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13334 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013335
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013336 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013337 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013338
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013339 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13340 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13341 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013342
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013343 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13344 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13345 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013346
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013347 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013348 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13349 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13350 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13351 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013352 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013353 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013354
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013355 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13356 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013357
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013358 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13359 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13360 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13361 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13362 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13363 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13364 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13365 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13366 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013367
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013368 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13369 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013370 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13371 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13372 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013373 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013374
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013375 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013376 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013377
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013378agent-send <string>
13379 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13380 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13381 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13382 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13383 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13384
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013385agent-inter <delay>
13386 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13387 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13388
13389 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13390 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13391 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13392 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13393 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13394 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13395 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13396 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13397 of backends use the same servers.
13398
13399 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13400
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013401agent-addr <addr>
13402 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13403
13404 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13405 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13406 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13407 hostname, it will be resolved.
13408
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013409agent-port <port>
13410 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13411
13412 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13413
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013414allow-0rtt
13415 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013416 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13417 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013418
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013419alpn <protocols>
13420 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13421 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13422 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013423 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013424 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13425 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13426 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13427 now obsolete NPN extension.
13428 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13429 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13430
13431 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013433backup
13434 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13435 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13436 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13437 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013438 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13439 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013440
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013441ca-file <cafile>
13442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13443 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13444 server's certificate.
13445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013446check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013447 This option enables health checks on a server:
13448 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13449 considered available.
13450 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13451 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13452 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13453 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13454 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13455 set.
13456 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13457 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13458 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13459 exchanges succeed.
13460
13461 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13462 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13463 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13464 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13465 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013466 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013467 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13468
13469 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13470 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13471
13472 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13473 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13474
13475 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13476 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13477 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13478 available.
13479
13480 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13481 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13482 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13483
13484 Example:
13485 # simple tcp check
13486 backend foo
13487 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13488 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13489 backend foo
13490 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13491 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13492 backend foo
13493 option tcp-check
13494 tcp-check connect
13495 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013496
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013497check-send-proxy
13498 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13499 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13500 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13501 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13502 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13503 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13504 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13505
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013506check-alpn <protocols>
13507 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13508 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13509 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13510
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013511check-proto <name>
13512 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13513 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13514 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13515 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013516 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013517 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13518 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13519
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013520check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013521 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013522 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13523 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013524
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013525check-ssl
13526 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13527 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13528 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13529 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013530 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013531 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13532 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013534 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13535 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013536
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013537check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013538 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013539 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13540 for normal traffic.
13541
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013542ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13544 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13545 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013546 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13547 information and recommendations see e.g.
13548 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13549 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13550 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013551
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013552ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13553 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13554 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13555 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13556 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013557 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13558 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13559 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013561cookie <value>
13562 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13563 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13564 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13565 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13566 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13567 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13568 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13569
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013570crl-file <crlfile>
13571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13572 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13573 to verify server's certificate.
13574
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013575crt <cert>
13576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13577 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13578 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13579 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13580 certificate request.
13581
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013582disabled
13583 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13584 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13585 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13586 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13587 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013588 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013589
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013590enabled
13591 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13592 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13593 default value.
13594 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13595 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013597error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013598 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13599 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13600 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013602 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013604fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013605 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13606 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13607 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13608
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013609force-sslv3
13610 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13611 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013612 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013613 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013614
13615force-tlsv10
13616 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013617 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013618 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013619
13620force-tlsv11
13621 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013622 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013623 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013624
13625force-tlsv12
13626 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013627 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013628 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013629
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013630force-tlsv13
13631 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13632 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013633 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013635id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013636 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13637 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13638 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013639
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013640init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13641 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13642 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013644 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13645 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13646 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13647 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13648 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13649 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13650 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13651 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13652 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013653 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013654 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13655 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13656 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13657 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13658 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13659 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013661
13662 Example:
13663 defaults
13664 # never fail on address resolution
13665 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013667inter <delay>
13668fastinter <delay>
13669downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013670 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13671 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13672 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13673 between checks depending on the server state :
13674
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013675 Server state | Interval used
13676 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13677 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13678 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13679 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13680 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13681 or yet unchecked. |
13682 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13683 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13684 | "inter" otherwise.
13685 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013687 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13688 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13689 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13690 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013691 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13692 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13693 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13694 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13695 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013696
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013697log-proto <logproto>
13698 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13699 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13700 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13701 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013703maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013704 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13705 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013706 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13707 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013708 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13709 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13710 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13711 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13712
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013713 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13714 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13715 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13716 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13717 than 50 concurrent requests.
13718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013719maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013720 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13721 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13722 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13723 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013724 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13725 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13726 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13727 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13728 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13729 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13730 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013731
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013732max-reuse <count>
13733 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13734 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13735 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13736 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13737 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13738 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13739 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13740 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013742minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013743 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13744 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13745 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13746 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13747 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13748 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013749 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013750 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013751
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013752namespace <name>
13753 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13754 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13755 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13756 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13757
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013758no-agent-check
13759 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13760 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13761 default value.
13762 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13763 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13764
13765no-backup
13766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13768 default value.
13769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13770 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13771
13772no-check
13773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13775 default value.
13776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13777 "default-server" "check" setting.
13778
13779no-check-ssl
13780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13782 default value.
13783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13784 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13785
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013786no-send-proxy
13787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13789 default value.
13790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13791 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13792
13793no-send-proxy-v2
13794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13796 default value.
13797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13798 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13799
13800no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13801 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13802 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13803 default value.
13804 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13805 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13806
13807no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13810 default value.
13811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13812 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13813
13814no-ssl
13815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13817 default value.
13818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13819 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13820
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013821no-ssl-reuse
13822 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13823 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13824 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13825 and for paranoid users.
13826
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013827no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013828 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13829 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013830 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013831
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013832 Supported in default-server: No
13833
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013834no-tls-tickets
13835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13836 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13837 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013838 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13839 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013840 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13841 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13842 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013843 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013844
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013845no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013846 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013847 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13848 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013849 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13850 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013851 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013852
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013853 Supported in default-server: No
13854
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013855no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013856 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013857 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13858 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013859 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13860 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013861 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013862
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013863 Supported in default-server: No
13864
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013865no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013866 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013867 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13868 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013869 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13870 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013871 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013872
13873 Supported in default-server: No
13874
13875no-tlsv13
13876 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13877 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13878 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13879 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13880 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013881 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013882
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013883 Supported in default-server: No
13884
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013885no-verifyhost
13886 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13887 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13888 default value.
13889 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13890 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013891
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013892no-tfo
13893 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13894 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13895 default value.
13896 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13897 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13898
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013899non-stick
13900 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13901 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13902 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13903
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013904npn <protocols>
13905 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13906 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13907 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013908 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013909 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13910 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13911 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013913observe <mode>
13914 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13915 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13916 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13917 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13918 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13919 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013920 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013921
13922 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013924on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013925 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13926 Currently, four modes are available:
13927 - fastinter: force fastinter
13928 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13929 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13930 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13931 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13932
13933 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13934
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013935on-marked-down <action>
13936 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13937 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013938 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13939 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13940 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13941 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13942 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13943 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13944 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13945 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013946
13947 Actions are disabled by default
13948
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013949on-marked-up <action>
13950 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13951 Currently one action is available:
13952 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13953 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13954 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13955 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013956 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13957 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013958 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13959 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13960
13961 Actions are disabled by default
13962
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013963pool-low-conn <max>
13964 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13965 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13966 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13967 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13968 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13969 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13970 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13971 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13972 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13973 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13974 applying to "http-reuse".
13975
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013976pool-max-conn <max>
13977 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13978 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13979 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13980 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13981 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13982 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13983
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013984pool-purge-delay <delay>
13985 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013986 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013987 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013989port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013990 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13991 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13992 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13993 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13994 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13995 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13996
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013997proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013998 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13999 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14000 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14001 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014002 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014003 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014005redir <prefix>
14006 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14007 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14008 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14009 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14010 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14011 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14012 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14013 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014014 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014015 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014016 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14017 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14018 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14019 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14020
14021 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014023rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014024 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14025 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14026 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14027
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014028resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14029 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14030 server.
14031
14032 Available options:
14033
14034 * allow-dup-ip
14035 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14036 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14037 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14038 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14039 For such case, simply enable this option.
14040 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14041
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014042 * ignore-weight
14043 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14044 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14045 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14046
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014047 * prevent-dup-ip
14048 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14049 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14050 same fqdn.
14051 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14052
14053 Example:
14054 backend b_myapp
14055 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14056 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14057 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14058
14059 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14060 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14061 it
14062 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14063 different address
14064
14065 Default value: not set
14066
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014067resolve-prefer <family>
14068 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14069 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14070 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14071 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14072
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014073 Default value: ipv6
14074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014075 Example:
14076
14077 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014078
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014079resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014080 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014081 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014082 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014083 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14084 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014085 configured network, another address is selected.
14086
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014087 Example:
14088
14089 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014090
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014091resolvers <id>
14092 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14093 hostname.
14094
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014095 Example:
14096
14097 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014098
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014099 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014100
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014101send-proxy
14102 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14103 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14104 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14105 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014106 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14107 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14108 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14109 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14110 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14111 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14112 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14113 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14114 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14115 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014116 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14117 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014118
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014119send-proxy-v2
14120 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14121 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14122 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14123 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014124 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14125 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14126 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14127 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014128
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014129proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014130 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14131 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14132
14133 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14134 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14135 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14136 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14137 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14138 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14139 connection is supported).
14140 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14141 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14142 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14143 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14144 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14145 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14146 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014147
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014148send-proxy-v2-ssl
14149 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14150 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14151 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14152 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14153 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14154 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14155 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014156 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14157 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014158
14159send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14160 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14161 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14162 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14163 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14164 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14165 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14166 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14167 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014168 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14169 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014171slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014172 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14173 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14174 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14175 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14176 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14177 parameters :
14178
14179 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14180 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14181
14182 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14183 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14184 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14185 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14186
14187 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14188 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14189 seen as failed.
14190
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014191sni <expression>
14192 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14193 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14194 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14195 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014196 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14197 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014198 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014199 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14200 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014201
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014202source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014203source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014204source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014205 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14206 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14207 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14208 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14209
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014210 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14211 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14212 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14213 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14214 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14215 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14216 server.
14217
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014218 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14219 specifying the source address without port(s).
14220
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014221ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014222 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14223 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14224 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14225 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14226 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14227 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014228 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14229 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014230
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014231ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14232 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14233 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14234 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14235
14236ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14237 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14238 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14239 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14240
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014241ssl-reuse
14242 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14243 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14244 default value.
14245 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14246 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14247
14248stick
14249 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14250 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14251 default value.
14252 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14253 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014254
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014255socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014256 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014257 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14258 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14259
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014260tcp-ut <delay>
14261 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14262 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14263 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014264 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014265 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14266 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14267 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14268 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14269 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14270 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14271 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14272 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14273 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14274
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014275tfo
14276 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14277 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14278 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14279 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14280 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014281 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014283track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014284 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14285 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14286 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14287 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014288 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14289
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014290tls-tickets
14291 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14292 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14293 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014294 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14295 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14296 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014297 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014298 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014299
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014300verify [none|required]
14301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014302 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014303 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14304 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014305 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014306 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14307 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14308 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14309 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14310 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14311 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14312 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14313 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014314
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014315verifyhost <hostname>
14316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014317 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14318 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14319 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14320 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14321 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14322 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14323 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14324 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014326weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014327 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14328 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14329 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014330 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14331 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14332 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14333 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14334 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14335 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014336
14337
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143385.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14339-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014340
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014341HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14342using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014343configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014344This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14345can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14346workload.
14347This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14348resolution at run time.
14349Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14350carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14351
14352
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143535.3.1. Global overview
14354----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014355
14356As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14357different steps of the process life:
14358
14359 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14360 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14361 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14362
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014363 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14364 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014365
14366A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14367 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14368 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14369 resolution to know this new IP.
14370
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014371When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014372HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014373SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14374from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14375will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14376will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014377
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014378A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014379 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014380 first valid response.
14381
14382 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14383 servers return an error.
14384
14385
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143865.3.2. The resolvers section
14387----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014388
14389This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014390HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14391contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014392
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014393When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14394uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14395is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14396answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14397
14398When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014399used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014400
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014401 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14402 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14403 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014404
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014405 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14406 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014407
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014408 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14409 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14410 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014411
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014412For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14413following scenarios are possible:
14414
14415 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14416 ignored
14417
14418 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14419 applied
14420
14421 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14422 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14423
14424 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14425 retries the query with a new type
14426
14427 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14428 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014429
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014430As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14431a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014432<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014433
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014434
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014435resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014436 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014437
14438A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14439
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014440accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014441 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014442 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014443 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14444 by RFC 6891)
14445
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014446 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14447
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014448nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14449 DNS server description:
14450 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14451 <ip> : IP address of the server
14452 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14453
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014454parse-resolv-conf
14455 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14456 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14457 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14458
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014459hold <status> <period>
14460 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14461 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014462 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014463 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014464 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14465 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14466 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14467
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014468 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014469
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014470resolve_retries <nb>
14471 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14472 giving up.
14473 Default value: 3
14474
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014475 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14476 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14477 type.
14478
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014479timeout <event> <time>
14480 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14481 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14482 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014483 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14484 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014485 Default value: 1s
14486 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014487 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014488 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014489 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14490 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14491
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014492 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014493
14494 resolvers mydns
14495 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14496 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014497 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014498 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014499 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014500 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014501 hold other 30s
14502 hold refused 30s
14503 hold nx 30s
14504 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014505 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014506 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014507
14508
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145096. Cache
14510---------
14511
14512HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14513(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14514RAM.
14515
14516The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14517this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14518
14519If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14520independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14521when we try to allocate a new one.
14522
14523The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14524
14525It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14526"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14527for more details.
14528
14529When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14530replaced by "<CACHE>".
14531
14532
145336.1. Limitation
14534----------------
14535
14536The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14537
14538- If the response is not a 200
14539- If the response contains a Vary header
14540- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14541- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonea8e0812020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014542- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14543 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14544 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014545
14546- If the request is not a GET
14547- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14548- If the request contains an Authorization header
14549
14550
145516.2. Setup
14552-----------
14553
14554To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14555the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14556
14557
145586.2.1. Cache section
14559---------------------
14560
14561cache <name>
14562 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14563 size of cache is mandatory.
14564
14565total-max-size <megabytes>
14566 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14567 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14568
14569max-object-size <bytes>
14570 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14571 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14572 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14573
14574max-age <seconds>
14575 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14576 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14577 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14578 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14579 default.
14580
14581
145826.2.2. Proxy section
14583---------------------
14584
14585http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14586 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14587 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14588 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14589 after this one.
14590
14591http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14592 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14593 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14594 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14595 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14596
14597
14598Example:
14599
14600 backend bck1
14601 mode http
14602
14603 http-request cache-use foobar
14604 http-response cache-store foobar
14605 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14606
14607 cache foobar
14608 total-max-size 4
14609 max-age 240
14610
14611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146127. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14613----------------------------------
14614
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014615HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14617The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14618these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14619but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14620data called patterns.
14621
14622
146237.1. ACL basics
14624---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014625
14626The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14627content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14628from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14629simple :
14630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014632 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14634 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14637adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014638
14639In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014642
14643This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14644Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14645and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014646an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14647conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14648as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14649are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014650
14651ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14652'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14653which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14654
14655There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14656performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014658The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14659specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14660this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014661methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14662ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014663
14664Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14665 - boolean
14666 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14667 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14668 - string
14669 - data block
14670
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014671Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14672converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14673would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14674The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14675which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14676
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014677Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14678keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14679fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14680which are summarized in the table below :
14681
14682 +---------------------+-----------------+
14683 | Sample or converter | Default |
14684 | output type | matching method |
14685 +---------------------+-----------------+
14686 | boolean | bool |
14687 +---------------------+-----------------+
14688 | integer | int |
14689 +---------------------+-----------------+
14690 | ip | ip |
14691 +---------------------+-----------------+
14692 | string | str |
14693 +---------------------+-----------------+
14694 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14695 +---------------------+-----------------+
14696
14697Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14698matching method, see below.
14699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014700The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14701 - boolean
14702 - integer or integer range
14703 - IP address / network
14704 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14705 - regular expression
14706 - hex block
14707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014708The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14709
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014710 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14711 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014713 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014714 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014715 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014716 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014718The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14719read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14720if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14721lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14722will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14723beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14724a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14725lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14726exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14727
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014728The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14729parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14730ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14731a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14732check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14733
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014734The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14735socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14736file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014738Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14739loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14740
14741 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14742
14743In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14744the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14745case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14746as well.
14747
14748The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14749sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14750do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14751methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14752is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014753obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14755default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14756that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14757string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14758
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014759The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14760By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14761string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14762resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14763server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014764waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014765flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14766function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14769sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14770be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014771
14772 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14773 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14775 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14776 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14777 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014778
14779 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14780 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014782
14783 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014785
14786 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014789 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014790 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14791
14792 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14793 binary or string samples.
14794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14796 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14799 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14800 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14803 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14806 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14809 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14812 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014813 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14816 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14817 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014818
14819For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14820request, it is possible to do :
14821
14822 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14823
14824In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14825buffer, one would use the following acl :
14826
14827 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14828
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014829On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14830possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14831
14832 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14835criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14836method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14837to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14838criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14839the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014842the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14843For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14846 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14847 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14848 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014849
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014850
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014851The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14852types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14853combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14854brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14855default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857 +-------------------------------------------------+
14858 | Input sample type |
14859 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014860 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14862 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14863 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014864 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014865 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014866 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014867 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014868 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014870 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014872 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014874 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014876 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014878 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014880 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014882 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014884 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14886 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014888
14889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148907.1.1. Matching booleans
14891------------------------
14892
14893In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14894Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14895When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14896that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14897
14898Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14899return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14900"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14901
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149037.1.2. Matching integers
14904------------------------
14905
14906Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14907enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14908to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14909
14910Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14911matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14912lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014913
14914For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14915unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14916representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14917
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014918As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14919two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14920instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14921ranges and operators.
14922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014923For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014924operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14925Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14926of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014928Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014929
14930 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14931 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14932 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14933 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14934 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014936For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014937
14938 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14939
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014940This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14941
14942 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149457.1.3. Matching strings
14946-----------------------
14947
14948String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14949different forms :
14950
14951 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014952 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953
14954 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014955 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956
14957 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14958 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14959
14960 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14961 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14962
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014963 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014964 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14965 matches.
14966
14967 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14968 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14969 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014970
14971String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14972exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14973characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14974string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14975to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014976before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014977
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014978Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14979(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14980Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14981
14982Example:
14983 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14984 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149877.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14988---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014989
14990Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14991they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14992possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14993passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14994the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014995the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14996match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014997
14998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149997.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15000-------------------------------------
15001
15002It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15003not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15004a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15005to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15006digits may be used upper or lower case.
15007
15008Example :
15009 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15010 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15011
15012
150137.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15014---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015015
15016IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15017netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15018within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015019host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015020difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15021at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15022does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15023parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015024
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015025The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15026abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15027
15028 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15029 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15030 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15031 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15032 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15033 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15034 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15035 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15036
15037Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15038192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15039
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015040IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15041Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15042trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15043IPv6 patterns.
15044
15045HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15046following situations :
15047 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15048 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15049 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15050 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15051 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15052 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15053 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15054 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15055 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15056 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058
150597.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15060----------------------------------
15061
15062Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15063combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15064
15065 - AND (implicit)
15066 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15067 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15074indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15077"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15078requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15079is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15080
15081 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015082 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15083 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15084 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015085
15086To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15087and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15088
15089 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15090 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15091 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15092 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15093
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015094 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15096 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15097 use_backend www if host_www
15098
15099It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15100expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15101be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15102the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15103
15104 The following rule :
15105
15106 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015107 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108
15109 Can also be written that way :
15110
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015111 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112
15113It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15114to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15115simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15116sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15117good use is the following :
15118
15119 With named ACLs :
15120
15121 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15122 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15123 monitor fail if site_dead
15124
15125 With anonymous ACLs :
15126
15127 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15128
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015129See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15130keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131
15132
151337.3. Fetching samples
15134---------------------
15135
15136Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15137against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15138sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15139ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15140of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15141available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15142
15143This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15144Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15145compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15146deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15147
15148The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15149matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15150method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15151indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15152
15153As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15154when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15155mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15156the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15157ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15158
15159Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15160multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15161when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015162incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15163are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15165all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15166
15167Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15168 - name
15169 - name(arg1)
15170 - name(arg1,arg2)
15171
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015172
151737.3.1. Converters
15174-----------------
15175
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015176Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15177of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15178is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15179was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015180has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015181unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15182
15183These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15184sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15185the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015186support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015187
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015188A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15189support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15190supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15191(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15192bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015195
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001519651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15197 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15198 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15199 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15200 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15201 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15202
15203 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015204 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15205 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015206 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15207 frontend http-in
15208 bind *:8081
15209 default_backend servers
15210 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15211 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15212
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015213add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015214 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015215 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015216 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15217 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015218 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015219 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15220 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15221 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15222 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015223 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015224 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015225
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015226aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15227 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15228 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15229 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15230 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15231 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15232 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15233
15234 Example:
15235 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15236 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15237
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015238and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015239 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015240 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015241 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15242 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015243 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015244 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15245 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15246 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15247 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015248 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015249 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015250
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015251b64dec
15252 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15253 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15254
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015255base64
15256 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015257 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015258 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15259
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015260bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015261 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015262 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015263 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015264 presence of a flag).
15265
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015266bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15267 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15268 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015269 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015270
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015271concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15272 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15273 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15274 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15275 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15276 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15277 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15278 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15279 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15280 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15281 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015282 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015283 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015284 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15285 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015286
15287 Example:
15288 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15289 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15290 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015291 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015292 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15293
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015294cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015295 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15296 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015297
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015298crc32([<avalanche>])
15299 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15300 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15301 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15302 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15303 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15304 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15305 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15306 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15307 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15308 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015309 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15310
15311crc32c([<avalanche>])
15312 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15313 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15314 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15315 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15316 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15317 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15318 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15319 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015320
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015321cut_crlf
15322 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15323 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15324 updated.
15325
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015326da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015327 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15328 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15329 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15330 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015331 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015332 configuration language.
15333
15334 Example:
15335 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015336 bind *:8881
15337 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015338 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015339
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015340debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15341 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15342 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15343 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15344 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15345 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15346 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15347 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15348 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15349 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15350 printable sample types.
15351
15352 Example:
15353 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015354
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015355digest(<algorithm>)
15356 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15357 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15358
15359 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15360 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15361
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015362div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015363 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15364 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015365 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015366 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15367 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015368 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015369 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15370 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15371 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015373 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015374 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015375
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015376djb2([<avalanche>])
15377 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15378 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15379 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15380 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15381 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15382 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15383 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015384 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15385 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015386
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015387even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015388 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015389 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15390
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015391field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15392 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15393 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15394 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15395 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15396 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15397 fields.
15398
15399 Example :
15400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015405
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015406hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015407 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015408 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015409 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015410 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015411
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015412hex2i
15413 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015414 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015415
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015416htonl
15417 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15418 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15419 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15420 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15421
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015422hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15423 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15424 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15425 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15426 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15427
15428 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15429 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15430
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015431http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015432 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15433 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015434 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15435 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15436 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15437 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15438 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15439 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15440 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15441 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015443iif(<true>,<false>)
15444 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15445 string otherwise.
15446
15447 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015448 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015449
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015450in_table(<table>)
15451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15453 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015454 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015455 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15456
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015457ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15458 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015459 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015460 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15461 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15462 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15463 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15464 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015465
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015466json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015467 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015468 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015469 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015470 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15471 of errors:
15472 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15473 bytes, ...)
15474 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15475 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15476
15477 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15478 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15479 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15480 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15481 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15482 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015483 - "ascii" : never fails;
15484 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15485 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015486 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015487 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015488 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15489 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15490
15491 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015492 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015493
15494 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015495 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015496 capture request header user-agent len 150
15497 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015498
15499 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15500 GET / HTTP/1.0
15501 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15502
15503 Output log:
15504 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015506language(<value>[,<default>])
15507 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15508 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15509 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15510 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15511 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15512 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15513 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15514 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15515 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015516 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015517 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15518 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015519
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015520 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015521
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015522 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15523 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015524
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015525 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15526 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15527 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15528 use_backend spanish if es
15529 use_backend french if fr
15530 use_backend english if en
15531 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015532
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015533length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015534 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15535 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15536 type. The result is of type integer.
15537
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015538lower
15539 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15540 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15541 type. The result is of type string.
15542
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015543ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15544 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15545 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15546 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15547 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15548 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15549 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15550
15551 Example :
15552
15553 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015554 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015555 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15556
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015557ltrim(<chars>)
15558 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15559 representation of the input sample.
15560
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015561map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15562map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15563map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15564 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15565 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15566 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15567 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15568 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15569 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15570 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15571 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015573 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15574 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15575 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015576
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015577 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015578 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015579
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015580 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15581 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15582 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015584 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015586 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15587 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15588 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15589 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15590 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15591 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15592 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15593 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015594 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15595 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15596 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15598 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15599 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15600 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15601 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015602
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015603 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15604 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15605 the corresponding match text.
15606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015607 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15608 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15609 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15610 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15611 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015612
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015613 Example :
15614
15615 # this is a comment and is ignored
15616 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15617 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15618 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15619 | | | `---------- value
15620 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15621 | `---------------------------- key
15622 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15623
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015624mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015625 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15626 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015627 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015628 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15632 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15633 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015634 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015635 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015636
15637mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015638 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015639 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15640 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015641 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015642 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015643 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015644 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15645 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15646 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15647 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015648 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015649 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015650
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015651nbsrv
15652 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15653 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15654 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15655 map lookup.
15656
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015657neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015658 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15659 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15660 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15661 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015662
15663not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015664 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015665 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015666 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015667 absence of a flag).
15668
15669odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015670 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015671 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15672
15673or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015674 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015675 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015676 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15677 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15681 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15682 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015684 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015685
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015686protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15687 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15688 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15689 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15690 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15691 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15692 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15693 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15694 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15695 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15696 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15697 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15698
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015699regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015700 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15701 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15702 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15703 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15704 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15705 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15706 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15707 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15708 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015709 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15710 of characters with other ones.
15711
15712 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15713 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15714 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15715 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15716 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15717 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015718
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015719 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015720
15721 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15722 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15723 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015724 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015725
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015726 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15727 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15728
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015729 # capture groups and backreferences
15730 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015731 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015732 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15733
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015734capture-req(<id>)
15735 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15736 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15737
15738 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015739 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15740 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015741
15742capture-res(<id>)
15743 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15744 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15745
15746 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015747 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15748 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015749
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015750rtrim(<chars>)
15751 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15752 of the input sample.
15753
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015754sdbm([<avalanche>])
15755 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15756 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15757 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15758 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15759 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15760 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15761 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015762 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15763 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015764
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015765secure_memcmp(<var>)
15766 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15767 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15768 match.
15769
15770 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15771 performed in constant time.
15772
15773 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15774 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15775
15776 Example :
15777
15778 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15779 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15780 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15781 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15782
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015783set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015784 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15785 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15786 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015787 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015788 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15789 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015790 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015791 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15792 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015793 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015794 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015795
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015796sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015797 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015798 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15799
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015800sha2([<bits>])
15801 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15802 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15803
15804 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15805 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15806
15807 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15808 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15809
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015810srv_queue
15811 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15812 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15813 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15814 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15815 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15816
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015817strcmp(<var>)
15818 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15819 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15820 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15821 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15822 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15823 shorter).
15824
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015825 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15826 strings in constant time.
15827
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015828 Example :
15829
15830 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15831 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15832 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15833
15834
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015835sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015836 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15837 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015838 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015839 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15840 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015841 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015842 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15843 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015844 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015845 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15846 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015848 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015849
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015850table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15854 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15855 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15856 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15857
15858
15859table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15860 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15861 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15862 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15863 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15864 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15865 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15866
15867table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015871 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15872 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15873
15874table_conn_cur(<table>)
15875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15878 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15879 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15880
15881table_conn_rate(<table>)
15882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15884 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15885 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15886 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15887
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015888table_gpt0(<table>)
15889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15892 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15893 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15894
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015895table_gpc0(<table>)
15896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15899 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15900 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15901
15902table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15906 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15907 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15908 sample fetch keyword.
15909
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015910table_gpc1(<table>)
15911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15914 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15915 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15916
15917table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15921 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15922 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15923 sample fetch keyword.
15924
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015925table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015929 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15930 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15931
15932table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15935 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15936 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15937 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15938 keyword.
15939
15940table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015944 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15945 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15946
15947table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15950 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15951 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15952 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15953 keyword.
15954
15955table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015959 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15960 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15961 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15962 keyword.
15963
15964table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015967 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015968 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15969 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15970 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15971 keyword.
15972
15973table_server_id(<table>)
15974 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15975 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15976 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15977 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15978 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15979 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15980
15981table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015985 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15986 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15987 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15988 keyword.
15989
15990table_sess_rate(<table>)
15991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15994 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15995 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15996 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15997 keyword.
15998
15999table_trackers(<table>)
16000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16003 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16004 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16005 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16006 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16007 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16008 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16009 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16010
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016011upper
16012 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16013 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16014 type. The result is of type string.
16015
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016016url_dec([<in_form>])
16017 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16018 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16019 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16020 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16021 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16022 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016023
William Dauchy55ed7c42021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016024url_enc([<enc_type>])
16025 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16026 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16027 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16028 optional argument is here for future changes.
16029
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016030ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016031 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016032 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16033 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16034 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016035 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16036 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16037 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16038 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016039 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016040 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16041 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016042
16043 Example:
16044 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16045 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16046
16047 message Point {
16048 int32 latitude = 1;
16049 int32 longitude = 2;
16050 }
16051
16052 message PPoint {
16053 Point point = 59;
16054 }
16055
16056 message Rectangle {
16057 // One corner of the rectangle.
16058 PPoint lo = 48;
16059 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16060 PPoint hi = 49;
16061 }
16062
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016063 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16064 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16065 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016066
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016067 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16068 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016069 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016070 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16071
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016072 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016073
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016074 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016075
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016076 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16077 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16078 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016079
16080 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16081 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16082 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16083
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016084 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16085 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16086 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016087
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016088
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016089unset-var(<var name>)
16090 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16091 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16092 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16093 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16094 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16095 response),
16096 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16097 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16098 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16099 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16100
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016101utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16102 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16103 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16104 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16105 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16106 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16107 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16108
16109 Example :
16110
16111 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016113 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16114
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016115word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16116 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16117 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16118 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016119 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016120 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16121 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16122
16123 Example :
16124 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16125 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16127 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16128 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016129 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016130
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016131wt6([<avalanche>])
16132 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16133 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16134 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16135 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16136 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16137 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16138 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016139 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16140 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016141
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016142xor(<value>)
16143 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016144 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016145 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016146 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016147 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016148 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16149 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016150 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016151 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016154 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016155
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016156xxh32([<seed>])
16157 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16158 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16159 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16160 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16161 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16162 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16163 as cryptographically secure.
16164
16165xxh64([<seed>])
16166 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16167 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16168 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16169 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16170 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16171 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16172 as cryptographically secure.
16173
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016174
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176--------------------------------------------
16177
16178A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16179not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16180"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16181The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16182
16183always_false : boolean
16184 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16185 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16186
16187always_true : boolean
16188 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16189 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16190
16191avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016192 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16194 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16195 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16196 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16197 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16198 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16199 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16200 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16201 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16202 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16203 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16204 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16205 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016208 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16209 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16210 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16211 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016212 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16213
16214be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16215 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16216 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16217 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16218 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16219 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016220 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16221 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016222
16223 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16224 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16225 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16228 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16229 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16230 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016231 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16233 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016234
16235 Example :
16236 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16237 backend dynamic
16238 mode http
16239 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16240 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016241
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016242bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016243 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16244 of the string.
16245
16246bool(<bool>) : bool
16247 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16248 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16251 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016252 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16254 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016255
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016256 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016257 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016258 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16259
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016260 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16261 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016262
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016263 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016264 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016265 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016266 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016267 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016269 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016270
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016271 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16272 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016274 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016275
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016276cpu_calls : integer
16277 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16278 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16279 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16280 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16281 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16282 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16283
16284cpu_ns_avg : integer
16285 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16286 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16287 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16288 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16289 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16290 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16291 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16292 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16293 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16294 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16295 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16296
16297cpu_ns_tot : integer
16298 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16299 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16300 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16301 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16302 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16303 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16304 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16305 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16306 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16307 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16308 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16309 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16310 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16311
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016312date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016313 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016314
16315 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16316 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16317 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016318 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16319
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016320 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16321 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16322 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16323 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16324 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16325
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016326 Example :
16327
16328 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16329 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016330
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016331 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16332 # millisecond granularity
16333 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16334
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016335date_us : integer
16336 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16337 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16338 from the same timeval structure.
16339
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016340distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16341 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16342 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16343 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16344 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16345 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16346 list of supported tokens.
16347
16348distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16349 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16350 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16351 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16352 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16353 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16354 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16355 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16356 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16357 supported tokens.
16358
16359 Example :
16360 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16361 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16362 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16363 # send large files to the big farm
16364 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16365
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016366env(<name>) : string
16367 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16368 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16369 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16370 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16371 certain way.
16372
16373 Examples :
16374 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16375 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16376
16377 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16378 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016380fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16381 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016382 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16383 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16385 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016386 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16388 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016389
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016390fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16392 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16393 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16397 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16398 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16399 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16400 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16401 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16402 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16403 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016404
16405 Example :
16406 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16407 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16408 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16409 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16410 frontend mail
16411 bind :25
16412 mode tcp
16413 maxconn 100
16414 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16415 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16416 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16417 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016418
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016419hostname : string
16420 Returns the system hostname.
16421
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016422int(<integer>) : signed integer
16423 Returns a signed integer.
16424
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016425ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16426 Returns an ipv4.
16427
16428ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16429 Returns an ipv6.
16430
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016431lat_ns_avg : integer
16432 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16433 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16434 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16435 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16436 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16437 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16438 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16439 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16440 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016441 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16442 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16443 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16444 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16445 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16446 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016447
16448lat_ns_tot : integer
16449 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16450 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16451 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16452 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16453 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16454 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16455 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16456 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16457 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016458 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16459 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16460 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16461 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16462 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016463 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16464 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16465 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16466 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16467 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16468 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16469
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016470meth(<method>) : method
16471 Returns a method.
16472
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016473nbproc : integer
16474 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16475 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16476 and debugging purposes.
16477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016478nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16479 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16480 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16481 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016482 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16483 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16484 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016485
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016486prio_class : integer
16487 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16488 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16489 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16490
16491prio_offset : integer
16492 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16493 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16494 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16495 set-priority-offset".
16496
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016497proc : integer
16498 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16499 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16500 debugging purposes.
16501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016503 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16504 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16505 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016506 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16507 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16508 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16509 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16510 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16511
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016512rand([<range>]) : integer
16513 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16514 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16515 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16516 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16517 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16518
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016519uuid([<version>]) : string
16520 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16521 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16522 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016524srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16525 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16526 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16527 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16528 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16529 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016530 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16531 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16532
16533srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16534 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16535 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16536 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16537 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16538 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16539 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16540 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16541
16542 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16543 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016544
16545srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16546 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16547 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16548 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16551 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16552 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16553
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016554srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16555 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16556 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16557 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16558 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16559 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16560 fetch methods.
16561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16563 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16564 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016565 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16567 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016568 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016569 overloading servers).
16570
16571 Example :
16572 # Redirect to a separate back
16573 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16574 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16575 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16576
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016577srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16578 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16579 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16580 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16581
16582srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16583 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16584 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16585 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16586
16587srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16588 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16589 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16590 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16591
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016592stopping : boolean
16593 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16594 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16595 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16596
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016597str(<string>) : string
16598 Returns a string.
16599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16601 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16602 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16603
16604table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16605 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16606 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16607 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16608
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016609thread : integer
16610 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16611 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16612 and debugging purposes.
16613
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016614var(<var-name>) : undefined
16615 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016616 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16617 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016618 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016619 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16620 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016621 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016622 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16623 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016624 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016625 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016626
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166277.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628----------------------------------
16629
16630The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16631closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16632methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16633sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16634TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016635the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16636counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016637"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16638used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16639can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16640Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16641table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16642tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16643currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016645bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016646 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16647 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16648 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016650be_id : integer
16651 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016652 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16653 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016654
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016655be_name : string
16656 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016657 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16658 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016660dst : ip
16661 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16662 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16663 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16664 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016665 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16666 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16667 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16668 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16669 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16670 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671
16672dst_conn : integer
16673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16674 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16675 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16676 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16677 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16678 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16679 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16680 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016681
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016682dst_is_local : boolean
16683 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16684 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16685 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16686 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016687 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016688 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16689 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16690 it only once per connection.
16691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016692dst_port : integer
16693 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16694 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16695 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16696 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16697 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16698 an HTTP header.
16699
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016700fc_http_major : integer
16701 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16702 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16703 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16704
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016705fc_pp_authority : string
16706 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16707 if any.
16708
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016709fc_pp_unique_id : string
16710 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16711 if any.
16712
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016713fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16714 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16715 header.
16716
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016717fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16718 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16719 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16720 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16721 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16722 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16723 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16724
16725fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16726 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16727 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16728 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16729 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16730 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16731 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16732
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016733fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016734 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16735 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16736 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16737 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16738
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016739fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016740 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16741 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16742 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16743 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16744
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016745fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016746 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16747 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16748 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16749 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16750
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016751fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016752 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16753 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16754 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16755 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16756
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016757fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016758 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16759 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16760 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16761 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16762
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016763fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016764 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16765 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16766 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16767 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16768
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016769fe_defbe : string
16770 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16771 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773fe_id : integer
16774 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016775 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16777
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016778fe_name : string
16779 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16780 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16781 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16782
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016783sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016784sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16785sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16786sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016787 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16788 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16789 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16790
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016791sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016792sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16793sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16794sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016795 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16796 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16797 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016799sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016800sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16801sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16802sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016803 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16804 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016805 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16806 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16807 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016808
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016809 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016810 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16811 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016812 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16813 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16814 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016815 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16816 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16817
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016818sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16819sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16820sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16821sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16822 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16823 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16824 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16825 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16826 when a first ACL was verified.
16827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016828sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016829sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16830sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16831sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016832 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016833 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016835sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016836sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16837sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16838sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016839 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16840 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16841 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016843sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016844sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16845sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16846sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016847 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16848 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16849 See also src_conn_rate.
16850
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016851sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016852sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16853sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16854sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016855 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016856 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016857
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016858sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16859sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16860sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16861sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16862 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16863 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16864
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016865sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16866sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16867sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16868sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16869 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16870 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016872sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016873sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16874sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16875sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016876 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16877 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16878 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016879 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16880 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16881 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016882
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016883sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16884sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16885sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16886sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16887 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16888 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16889 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16890 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16891 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16892 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016894sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016895sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16896sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16897sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016899 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16900 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016902sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016903sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16904sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16905sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016906 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16907 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16908 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16909 src_http_err_rate.
16910
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016911sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016912sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16913sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16914sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016915 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016916 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16917 src_http_req_cnt.
16918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016919sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016920sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16921sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16922sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016923 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16924 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16925 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16926 src_http_req_rate.
16927
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016928sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016929sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16930sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16931sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016932 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016933 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16934 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16935 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16936 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016937
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016938 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016939 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16940 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016941 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16942
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016943sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16944sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16945sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16946sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16947 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16948 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16949 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16950 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16951 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16952
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016953sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016954sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16955sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16956sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016957 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16958 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16959 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016961sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016962sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16963sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16964sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016965 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16966 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16967 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016968
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016969sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016970sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16971sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16972sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016973 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016974 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16975 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16976 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016977 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016978 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16979
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016980sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016981sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16982sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16983sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016984 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16985 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16986 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16987 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16988 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016989 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016991sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016992sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16993sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16994sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016995 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16996 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16997 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16998
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016999sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017000sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17001sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17002sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017003 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17004 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017005 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017006 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17007 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017008 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17009 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17010 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017012so_id : integer
17013 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17014 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17015 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017016
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017017so_name : string
17018 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17019 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17020 strings instead of integers.
17021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017022src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017023 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17025 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17026 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017027 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17028 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17029 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017030 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17031 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17032 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17033 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17034 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17035 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17036 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017037
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017038 Example:
17039 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17040 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017042src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17043 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17044 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17045 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017046 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17049 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17050 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017051 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017052 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017054src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17055 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17056 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17057 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17058 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17059 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17060 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017061
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017062 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017063 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17064 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17065 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17066 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017067 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017068 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17069 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17070
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017071src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17072 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17073 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17074 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17075 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17076 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17077 was verified.
17078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017079src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017080 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017082 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017083 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017086 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17088 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017089 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017091src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17092 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17093 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17094 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017095 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017097src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017098 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017099 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017100 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017101 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017102
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017103src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17104 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17105 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17106 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17107 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17108
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017109src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17110 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17111 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17112 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17113 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017115src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017116 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017118 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17119 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017120 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17121 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17122 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017123
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017124src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17125 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17126 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17127 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17128 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17129 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17130 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17131 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017133src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017134 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017136 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017137 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17141 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17142 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17143 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17144 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017145 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017147src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017148 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017149 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17150 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017151 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017153src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17154 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17155 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17156 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017157 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017158 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017160src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17161 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17162 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17163 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017164 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17166 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017167
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017168 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017169 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017170 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017171 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017172
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017173src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17174 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17175 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17176 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17177 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17178 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17179 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17180
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017181src_is_local : boolean
17182 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17183 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17184 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17185 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017186 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017187 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17188 once per connection.
17189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017191 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17192 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17193 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17194 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17195 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017198 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17199 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17200 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17201 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17202 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017204src_port : integer
17205 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17206 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17207 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17208 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017210src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017211 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017212 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17213 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17214 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017215 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17218 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17219 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17220 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17221 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017222 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17225 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17226 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17227 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17228 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17229 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17230 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17231 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17232 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017233
17234 Example :
17235 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17236 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17237 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17238 listen ssh
17239 bind :22
17240 mode tcp
17241 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017242 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017243 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017244 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246srv_id : integer
17247 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17248 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017249 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017250
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017251srv_name : string
17252 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17253 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017254 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017255
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172567.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17260closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17261when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17262usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017263future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017264
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001726551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17266 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17267 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17268 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17269 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17270 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17271
17272 Example :
17273 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17274 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17275 # the request.
17276 frontend http-in
17277 bind *:8081
17278 default_backend servers
17279 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17280 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17281
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017282ssl_bc : boolean
17283 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17284 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017285 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17286 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017287
17288ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17289 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017290 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17291 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017292
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017293ssl_bc_alpn : string
17294 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17295 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017296 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017297 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17298 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17299 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17300 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17301 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017302 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17303 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017304
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017305ssl_bc_cipher : string
17306 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017307 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17308 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017309
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017310ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17311 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17312 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17313 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017314 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017315
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017316ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17317 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17318 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017319 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17320 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017321
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017322ssl_bc_npn : string
17323 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17324 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017325 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017326 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17327 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17328 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17329 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017330 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17331 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017332
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017333ssl_bc_protocol : string
17334 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017335 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17336 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017337
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017338ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017339 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017340 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017341 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17342 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017343
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017344ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17345 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17346 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17347 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017348 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017349
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017350ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17351 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17352 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017353 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17354 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017355
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017356ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17357 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17358 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17359 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017360 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017361
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017362ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17363 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017364 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17365 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017367ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17368 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17369 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17370 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17371 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17372 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017374ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17375 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17376 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17377 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17378 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017379
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017380ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017381 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17382 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17383 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17384 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17385 does not support resumed sessions.
17386
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017387ssl_c_der : binary
17388 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17389 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17390 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392ssl_c_err : integer
17393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17394 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17395 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17396 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17397 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017398
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017399ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17401 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17402 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17403 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17404 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17405 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17406 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17407 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017408 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17409 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17410 LDAP v3.
17411 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17412 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414ssl_c_key_alg : string
17415 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17416 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17417 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017419ssl_c_notafter : string
17420 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17421 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17422 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017424ssl_c_notbefore : string
17425 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17426 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17427 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017428
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017429ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17431 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17432 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17433 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17434 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17435 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17436 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17437 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017438 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17439 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17440 LDAP v3.
17441 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17442 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444ssl_c_serial : binary
17445 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17446 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17447 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17450 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17451 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17452 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017453 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17454 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17455
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017456 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017457 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17460 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17461 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17462 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017464ssl_c_used : boolean
17465 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17466 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017468ssl_c_verify : integer
17469 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17470 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17471 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17472 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017474ssl_c_version : integer
17475 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17476 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017477
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017478ssl_f_der : binary
17479 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17480 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17481 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17482
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017483ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017484 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17485 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17486 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17487 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017488 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017489 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17490 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17491 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017492 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17493 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17494 LDAP v3.
17495 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17496 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017498ssl_f_key_alg : string
17499 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17500 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17501 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017503ssl_f_notafter : string
17504 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17505 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17506 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508ssl_f_notbefore : string
17509 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17510 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17511 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017512
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017513ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17515 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17516 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17517 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17518 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17519 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17520 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17521 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017522 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17523 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17524 LDAP v3.
17525 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17526 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017528ssl_f_serial : binary
17529 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17530 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17531 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017532
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017533ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17534 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17535 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17536 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017538ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17539 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17540 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17541 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017543ssl_f_version : integer
17544 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17545 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17546
17547ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017548 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17549 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17550 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017552 Example :
17553 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17554 listen http-https
17555 bind :80
17556 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17557 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17558
17559ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17560 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17561 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17562
17563ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017564 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017565 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17566 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17567 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17568 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17569 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17570 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17571 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17572 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574ssl_fc_cipher : string
17575 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17576 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017577
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017578ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17579 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17580 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017581 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017582
17583ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17584 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17585 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017586 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017587
17588ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17589 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17590 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17591 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017592 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017593 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017594
17595ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17596 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17597 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017598 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017599
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017600ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17601 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17602 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17603 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17604
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017605ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17606 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17607 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17608 transport layer.
17609 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17610 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17611 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17612 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17613
17614ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17615 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17616 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17617 transport layer.
17618 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17619 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17620 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17621 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17622
17623ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17624 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17625 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17626 transport layer.
17627 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17628 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17629 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17630 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17631
17632ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17633 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17634 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17635 transport layer.
17636 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17637 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17638 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17639 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17640
17641ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17642 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17643 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17644 transport layer.
17645 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17646 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17647 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17648 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017651 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17652 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017653 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17654 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17655 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17656 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017657
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017658ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17659 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17660 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17661 wait until the handshake happened.
17662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17664 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017665 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17666 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017667 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017668 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017669
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017670ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017671 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017672 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17673 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017676 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017677 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17678 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17679 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17680 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17681 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17682 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17683 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685ssl_fc_protocol : string
17686 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17687 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017688
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017689ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017690 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017691 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17692 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017693
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017694ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17695 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17696 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17697 transport layer.
17698 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17699 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17700 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17701 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17702
17703ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17704 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17705 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17706 transport layer.
17707 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17708 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17709 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17710 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17711
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017712ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17713 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17714 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17715 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17718 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17719 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17720 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17721 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017722
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017723ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17724 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17725 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17726 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17727 BoringSSL.
17728
17729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730ssl_fc_sni : string
17731 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17732 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17733 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17734 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17735 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17736
17737 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17738 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17739 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017740 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017741 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17745 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17748 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17749 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017750
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017751ssl_s_der : binary
17752 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17753 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17754 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17755
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017756ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17757 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17758 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17759 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17760 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17761 does not support resumed sessions.
17762
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017763ssl_s_key_alg : string
17764 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17765 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17766 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17767
17768ssl_s_notafter : string
17769 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17770 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17771 transport layer.
17772
17773ssl_s_notbefore : string
17774 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17775 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17776 transport layer.
17777
17778ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17779 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17780 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17781 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17782 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17783 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17784 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017785 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17786 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017787 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17788 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17789 LDAP v3.
17790 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17791 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17792
17793ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17794 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17795 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17796 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17797 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17798 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17799 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017800 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17801 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017802 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17803 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17804 LDAP v3.
17805 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17806 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17807
17808ssl_s_serial : binary
17809 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17810 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17811 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17812
17813ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17814 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17815 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17816 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17817
17818ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17819 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17820 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17821 layer.
17822
17823ssl_s_version : integer
17824 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17825 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017826
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178277.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017828------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17831sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17832only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17833For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17834be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17835can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17836sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17837for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17838content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017840payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017841 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17843 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17846 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017847 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017850req.len : integer
17851req_len : integer (deprecated)
17852 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17853 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17854 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17855 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17856 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17857 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17858 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17859 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17862 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017863 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17864 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17865 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17866 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868 ACL alternatives :
17869 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017871req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17872 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17873 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17874 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17875 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017877 ACL alternatives :
17878 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017882req.proto_http : boolean
17883req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17884 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17885 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17886 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17887 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17888 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17889 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17890 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892 Example:
17893 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17894 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17895 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017896 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017898req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17899rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17900 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17901 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17902 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17903 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17904 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17905 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17906 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017908 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17909 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17910 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17911 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17912 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17913 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017915 ACL derivatives :
17916 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017918 Example :
17919 listen tse-farm
17920 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17921 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17922 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17923 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17924 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17925 persist rdp-cookie
17926 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17927 # This is only useful makes sense if
17928 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17929 stick-table type string size 204800
17930 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17931 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17932 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017934 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17935 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17938rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17939 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17940 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17941 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17942 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017944 ACL derivatives :
17945 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017946
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017947req.ssl_alpn : string
17948 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17949 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17950 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17951 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17952 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17953 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017954 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017955
17956 Examples :
17957 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17958 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17959 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017960 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017961 default_backend bk_default
17962
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017963req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17964 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17965 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017966 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17967 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17968 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17969 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17970 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17973req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17974 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17975 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17976 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17977 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17978 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17979 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17980 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982req.ssl_sni : string
17983req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17984 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17985 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17986 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17987 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17988 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017989 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17990 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17991 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17992 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17993 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17994 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17995 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17996 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17997 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017999 ACL derivatives :
18000 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018002 Examples :
18003 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18004 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18005 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18006 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18007 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018008
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018009req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18010 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18011 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18012 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18013 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18014 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18015 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18016 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18017 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18018 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020req.ssl_ver : integer
18021req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18022 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18023 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18024 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18025 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18026 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18027 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18028 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018029 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018030 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018032 ACL derivatives :
18033 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018034
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018035res.len : integer
18036 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18037 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18038 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18039 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18040 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18041 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18042 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018043 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018045res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18046 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018047 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018048 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018049 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018050 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18053 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18054 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18055 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018056 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18057 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018059 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018060
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018061res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18062rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18063 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18064 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18065 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18066 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18067 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18068 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18069 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071wait_end : boolean
18072 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18073 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018074 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018075 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18076 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018077 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18079 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081 Examples :
18082 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18083 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18084 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018086 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18087 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18088 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18089 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18090 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18091 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18092 tcp-request content reject
18093
18094
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180957.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018096--------------------------------------
18097
18098It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18099This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18100data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18101its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18102HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18103content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18104to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18105more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18106response are indexed.
18107
18108base : string
18109 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18110 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18111 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18112 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18113 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18114 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18115 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18116 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18117
18118 ACL derivatives :
18119 base : exact string match
18120 base_beg : prefix match
18121 base_dir : subdir match
18122 base_dom : domain match
18123 base_end : suffix match
18124 base_len : length match
18125 base_reg : regex match
18126 base_sub : substring match
18127
18128base32 : integer
18129 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18130 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18131 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018132 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18133 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18134 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135
18136base32+src : binary
18137 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18138 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18139 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18140 per-URL counters.
18141
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018142capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18143 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18144 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18145 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18146
18147capture.req.method : string
18148 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18149 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18150 because it's allocated.
18151
18152capture.req.uri : string
18153 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18154 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18155 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18156 allocated.
18157
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018158capture.req.ver : string
18159 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18160 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18161 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18162
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018163capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18164 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18165 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18166 The first entry is an index of 0.
18167 See also: "capture response header"
18168
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018169capture.res.ver : string
18170 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18171 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18172 persistent flag.
18173
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018174req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018175 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18176 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18177 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018178
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018179req.body_param([<name>) : string
18180 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18181 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18182 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18183 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18184 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18185 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18186 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18187 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18188 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18189 given.
18190
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018191req.body_len : integer
18192 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18193 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018194 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18195 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018196
18197req.body_size : integer
18198 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018199 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18200 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202req.cook([<name>]) : string
18203cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18204 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18205 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18206 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18207 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18208 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18209 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18210 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18211 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18212
18213 ACL derivatives :
18214 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18215 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18216 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18217 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18218 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18219 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18220 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18221 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18224cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18225 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18226 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18229cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18230 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18231 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18232 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18233 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18236 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18237 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18238 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18239 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018240 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18242 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18243 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18244 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18247 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18248 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18249 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18250 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018251 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018253req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018254 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18255 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18256 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18257 with headers such as User-Agent.
18258
18259 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18260 found.
18261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018262 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18263 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18264 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018265 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18268 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18269 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018270 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18271 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018274 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18275 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18276 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18277 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18278 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18279 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18280 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18281
18282 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18283 found.
18284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18286 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18287 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018288 with -1 being the last one.
18289
18290 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18291 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293 ACL derivatives :
18294 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18295 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18296 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18297 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18298 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18299 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18300 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18301 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18302
18303req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18304hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18305 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18306 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018307 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18308 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18309 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18310
18311 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18312 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18313 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18314
18315 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316
18317req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18318hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18319 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18320 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18321 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018322 of every header is checked.
18323
18324 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18325
18326 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327
18328req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18329hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18330 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18331 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18332 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018333
18334 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18335
18336 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018338req.hdrs : string
18339 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18340 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18341 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18342 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18343
18344req.hdrs_bin : binary
18345 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18346 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18347 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18348 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18349 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18350 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18351
18352 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018353
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018354 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18355 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18358 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18359 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18360 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18361 basic auth is supported.
18362
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018363http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18364 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18365 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18366 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18367 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18369 basic auth is supported.
18370
18371 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018372 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18373 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18374 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18375 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018377http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018378 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18379 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18380 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018381
18382http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018383 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18384 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18385 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018386
18387http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018388 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18389 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18390 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018393 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18394 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018395 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18396 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018398method : integer + string
18399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18400 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18401 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18402 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18403 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18404 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18405 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407 ACL derivatives :
18408 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018410 Example :
18411 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18412 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18413 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415path : string
18416 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18417 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18418 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18419 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18420 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018421 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424 ACL derivatives :
18425 path : exact string match
18426 path_beg : prefix match
18427 path_dir : subdir match
18428 path_dom : domain match
18429 path_end : suffix match
18430 path_len : length match
18431 path_reg : regex match
18432 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018433
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018434pathq : string
18435 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18436 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18437 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18438 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18439 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18440 result in both cases.
18441
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018442query : string
18443 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18444 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18445 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18446 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018447 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018448 which stops before the question mark.
18449
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018450req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18451 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18452 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18453 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18454 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456req.ver : string
18457req_ver : string (deprecated)
18458 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18459 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18460 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462 ACL derivatives :
18463 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018464
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018465res.body : binary
18466 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18467 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018468 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18469
18470 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018471
18472res.body_len : integer
18473 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18474 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018475 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18476
18477 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018478
18479res.body_size : integer
18480 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18481 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18482 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18483 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018484 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18485
18486 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018487
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018488res.cache_hit : boolean
18489 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18490 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18491
18492res.cache_name : string
18493 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18494 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18495 empty string.
18496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497res.comp : boolean
18498 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18499 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18500 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502res.comp_algo : string
18503 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18504 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18505 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018507res.cook([<name>]) : string
18508scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18509 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18510 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018511 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18512
18513 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515 ACL derivatives :
18516 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18519scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18520 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18521 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018522 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18523
18524 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18527scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18528 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18529 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018530 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18531
18532 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018534res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018535 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18536 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18537
18538 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18539 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18540
18541 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18542
18543 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018546 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18547 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18548
18549 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18550 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18551
18552 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018554res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18555shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018556 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18557 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18558
18559 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimeter. If
18560 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18561
18562 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564 ACL derivatives :
18565 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18566 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18567 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18568 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18569 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18570 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18571 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18572 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18573
18574res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18575shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018576 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18577 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18578
18579 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
18580 delimeter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
18581
18582 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018584res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18585shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018586 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
18587 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18588
18589 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18590
18591 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018592
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018593res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18594 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18595 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18596 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018597 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18598
18599 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18602shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018603 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
18604 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18605
18606 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18607
18608 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018609
18610res.hdrs : string
18611 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18612 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18613 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018614 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18615
18616 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018617
18618res.hdrs_bin : binary
18619 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18620 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18621 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18622 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18623 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18624 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18625 (length of 0 for both).
18626
18627 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18628
18629 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18630 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632res.ver : string
18633resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18634 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018635 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
18636
18637 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018639 ACL derivatives :
18640 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018642set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18643 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18644 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018645 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018646 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18649 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018651status : integer
18652 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18653 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus7fb56282021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018654 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
18655
18656 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018657
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018658unique-id : string
18659 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18660 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18661 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18662 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18663 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18664 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018666url : string
18667 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18668 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18669 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18670 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18671 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18672 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18673 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675 ACL derivatives :
18676 url : exact string match
18677 url_beg : prefix match
18678 url_dir : subdir match
18679 url_dom : domain match
18680 url_end : suffix match
18681 url_len : length match
18682 url_reg : regex match
18683 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685url_ip : ip
18686 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18687 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18688 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18689 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18690 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18691 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18692 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694url_port : integer
18695 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18696 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18697 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18698 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018699
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018700urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18701url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18703 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018704 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18705 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18706 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18707 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018708 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18709 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018710 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18711 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713 ACL derivatives :
18714 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18715 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18716 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18717 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18718 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18719 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18720 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18721 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018722
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724 Example :
18725 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18726 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18727 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18728 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018729
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018730urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018731 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18732 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18733 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018734
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018735url32 : integer
18736 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18737 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18738 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18739 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18740 is an unsigned integer.
18741
18742url32+src : binary
18743 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18744 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18745 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18746
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018747
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200187487.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018749---------------------------------------
18750
18751This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18752used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18753purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18754There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18755or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18756any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18757for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18758
18759internal.htx.data : integer
18760 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18761 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18762
18763internal.htx.free : integer
18764 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18765 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18766
18767internal.htx.free_data : integer
18768 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18769 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18770
18771internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18772 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18773 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18774 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18775
18776internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18777 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18778 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18779
18780internal.htx.size : integer
18781 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18782 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18783
18784internal.htx.used : integer
18785 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18786 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18787 direction.
18788
18789internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18790 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18791 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18792 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18793 of the special value :
18794 * head : The oldest inserted block
18795 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018796 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018797
18798internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18799 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18800 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18801 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18802 integer or one of the special value :
18803 * head : The oldest inserted block
18804 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018805 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018806
18807internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18808 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18809 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18810 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18811 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18812
18813 * head : The oldest inserted block
18814 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018815 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018816
18817internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18818 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18819 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18820 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18821 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18822
18823 * head : The oldest inserted block
18824 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018825 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018826
18827internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18828 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18829 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18830 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18831 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18832
18833 * head : The oldest inserted block
18834 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018835 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018836
18837internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18838 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18839 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18840 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18841 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18842
18843 * head : The oldest inserted block
18844 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018845 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018846
18847internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18848 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18849 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18850 it returns false.
18851
18852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200188537.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018854---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018856Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18857every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018858order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018860ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18861---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018862FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018863HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018864HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18865HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018866HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18867HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18868HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18869HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18870LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018871METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018872METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018873METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18874METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18875METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18876METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018877METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018878METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018879RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018880REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018881TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018882WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18883---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018884
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188868. Logging
18887----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018888
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018889One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18890provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18891very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18892provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18893state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018894to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018895headers.
18896
18897In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18898about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18899send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18900
18901 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18902 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18903 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18904 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18905 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018906 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018907 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018908
18909The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18910allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18911as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18912while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18913real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18914delay.
18915
18916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189178.1. Log levels
18918---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018919
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018920TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018921source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018922HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18923in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18924track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18925syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18926about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018927
18928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189298.2. Log formats
18930----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018931
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018932HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018933and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18934slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18935options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018936
18937 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18938 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18939 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18940 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18941 extents.
18942
18943 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18944 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18945 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18946 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18947 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18948
18949 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18950 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18951 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18952 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18953 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18954
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018955 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18956 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18957 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18958 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18959
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018960 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18961
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018962Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18963specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18964field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18965servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18966always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18967identifier.
18968
18969Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18970 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18971 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18972 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18973 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18974
18975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189768.2.1. Default log format
18977-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018978
18979This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18980as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18981format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18982
18983 Example :
18984 listen www
18985 mode http
18986 log global
18987 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18988
18989 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18990 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18991 (www/HTTP)
18992
18993 Field Format Extract from the example above
18994 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18995 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18996 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18997 4 'to' to
18998 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18999 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19000
19001Detailed fields description :
19002 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19003 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19004 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19005 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19006 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19007 and processed the connection.
19008 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19009
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019010In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19011"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19012connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19013
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019014It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19015will eventually disappear.
19016
19017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190188.2.2. TCP log format
19019---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019020
19021The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19022is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19023information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19024counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19025emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19026environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19027the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19028sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019029specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19030not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19031fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19032marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019033
19034 Example :
19035 frontend fnt
19036 mode tcp
19037 option tcplog
19038 log global
19039 default_backend bck
19040
19041 backend bck
19042 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19043
19044 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19045 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19046 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19047
19048 Field Format Extract from the example above
19049 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19050 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19051 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19052 4 frontend_name fnt
19053 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19054 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19055 7 bytes_read* 212
19056 8 termination_state --
19057 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19058 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19059
19060Detailed fields description :
19061 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019062 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19063 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19064 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019065 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019066 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019067 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019068
19069 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019070 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19071 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19072 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019073
19074 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19075 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19076 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019077 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19078 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19079 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19080 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019081
19082 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19083 and processed the connection.
19084
19085 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19086 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19087 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19088 applications.
19089
19090 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19091 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19092 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19093 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19094 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19095
19096 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19097 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19098 See "Timers" below for more details.
19099
19100 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19101 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19102 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19103 "Timers" below for more details.
19104
19105 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019106 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019107 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19108 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19109 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19110 details.
19111
19112 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19113 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19114 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19115 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19116 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19117
19118 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19119 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19120 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19121 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19122 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19123 for more details.
19124
19125 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019126 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019127 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19128 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19129 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019130 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019131
19132 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19133 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19134 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19135 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19136 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19137 caused by a denial of service attack.
19138
19139 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19140 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19141 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19142 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19143 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19144 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19145 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19146 denial of service attack.
19147
19148 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19149 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19150 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19151 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19152 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19153 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19154 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19155 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19156 be processed than on other servers.
19157
19158 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19159 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19160 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19161 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19162 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19163 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19164 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19165 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19166 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19167 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19168 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19169 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19170 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19171
19172 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19173 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19174 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19175 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19176 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19177 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019178 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019179 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19180
19181 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19182 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19183 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19184 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19185 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19186 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019187 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019188 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19189 occurs.
19190
19191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191928.2.3. HTTP log format
19193----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019194
19195The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19196is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19197the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19198are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19199emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19200generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19201"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19202which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019203frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19204is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019205
19206Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19207slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19208with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19209
19210 Example :
19211 frontend http-in
19212 mode http
19213 option httplog
19214 log global
19215 default_backend bck
19216
19217 backend static
19218 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19219
19220 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19221 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19222 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019223 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019224
19225 Field Format Extract from the example above
19226 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19227 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019228 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019229 4 frontend_name http-in
19230 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019231 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019232 7 status_code 200
19233 8 bytes_read* 2750
19234 9 captured_request_cookie -
19235 10 captured_response_cookie -
19236 11 termination_state ----
19237 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19238 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19239 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19240 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19241 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019242
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019243Detailed fields description :
19244 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019245 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19246 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19247 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019248 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019249 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019250 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019251
19252 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019253 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19254 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19255 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019256
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019257 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19258 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019259
19260 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19261 and processed the connection.
19262
19263 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19264 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19265 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19266
19267 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19268 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19269 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19270 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19271 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19272 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19273
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019274 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19275 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19276 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019277 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019278 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19279 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019280 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19281 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019282
19283 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19284 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019285 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019286
19287 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19288 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019289 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19290 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019291
19292 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19293 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19294 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19295 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19296 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019297 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19298 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019299
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019300 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19301 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19302 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19303 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19304 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19305 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19306 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019307 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019308
19309 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19310 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19311 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19312
19313 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19314 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019315 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019316 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19317 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19318 overflowing.
19319
19320 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19321 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19322 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19323 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19324 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19325 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19326 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19327 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19328
19329 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19330 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19331 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19332 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19333 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19334 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19335 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19336 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19337
19338 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19339 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19340 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19341 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19342 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19343 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19344 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19345
19346 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019347 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019348 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19349 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19350 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019351 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019352 system.
19353
19354 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19355 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19356 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19357 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19358 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19359 caused by a denial of service attack.
19360
19361 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19362 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19363 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19364 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19365 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19366 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19367 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19368 denial of service attack.
19369
19370 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19371 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19372 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19373 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19374 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19375 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19376 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19377 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19378 processed than on other servers.
19379
19380 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19381 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19382 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19383 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19384 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19385 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19386 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19387 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19388 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19389 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19390 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19391 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19392 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19393
19394 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19395 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19396 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19397 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19398 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19399 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019400 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019401 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19402
19403 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19404 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19405 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19406 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19407 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19408 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019409 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019410 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19411 occurs.
19412
19413 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19414 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19415 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19416 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19417 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19418 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19419 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19420 cookies" below for more details.
19421
19422 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19423 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19424 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19425 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19426 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19427 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19428 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19429 and cookies" below for more details.
19430
19431 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19432 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19433 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19434 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19435 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19436 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19437 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19438 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19439
19440
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200194418.2.4. Custom log format
19442------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019443
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019444The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019445mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019447HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019448Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19449separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19450prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19451
19452Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19453variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019454("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019455
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019456If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019457as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019458less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19459the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19460
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019461Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19462"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19463delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19464preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019465
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019466Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19467'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19468https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19469such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19470
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019471Flags are :
19472 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019473 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019474 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19475 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019476
19477 Example:
19478
19479 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19480 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19481
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019482 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19483
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019484At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19485
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019486 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19487 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019488
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019489the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019490
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019491 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19492 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19493 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019494
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019495and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19496
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019497 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19498 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019499
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019500Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19501
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019502 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019503 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019504 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19505 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19506 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019507 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19508 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19509 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019510 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019511 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdebf9f0f942020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019512 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019513 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019514 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19515 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019516 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019517 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019518 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019519 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019520 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019521 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019522 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019523 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19524 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19525 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19526 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19527 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019528 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019529 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019530 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019531 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019532 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019533 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19534 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019535 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19536 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19537 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019538 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019539 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19540 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019541 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019542 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19543 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19544 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019545 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019546 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019547 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19548 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19549 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19550 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019551 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019552 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019553 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019554 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019555 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019556 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019557 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19558 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19559 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019560 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019561 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19562 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019563 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019564 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19565 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019566 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019567 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019568 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019569 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019570
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019571 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019572
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019573
195748.2.5. Error log format
19575-----------------------
19576
19577When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19578protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19579By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19580"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019581will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019582logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19583
19584The format looks like this :
19585
19586 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19587 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19588 Connection error during SSL handshake
19589
19590 Field Format Extract from the example above
19591 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19592 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19593 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19594 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19595 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19596
19597These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19598failures.
19599
19600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196018.3. Advanced logging options
19602-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019603
19604Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19605just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19606options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19607for more information about their usage.
19608
19609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196108.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19611------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019612
19613It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19614haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19615commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19616monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19617ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19618
19619 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19620 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19621 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19622 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19623
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019624 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19625 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019626
19627 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19628 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19629 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19630
19631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196328.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19633----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019634
19635The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19636what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19637or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019638"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019639just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19640log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19641after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19642is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19643with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19644with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19645
19646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196478.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19648------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019649
19650Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19651for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19652"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19653retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19654raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19655a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19656file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19657you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19658"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19659
19660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196618.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19662--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019663
19664Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19665multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19666them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19667"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19668logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19669error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19670and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19671too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19672useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19673alternative.
19674
19675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196768.4. Timing events
19677------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019678
19679Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19680reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19681the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19682frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019683mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19684addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19685
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019686Timings events in HTTP mode:
19687
19688 first request 2nd request
19689 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19690 t tr t tr ...
19691 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19692 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19693 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19694 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019695 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019696 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19697
19698Timings events in TCP mode:
19699
19700 TCP session
19701 |<----------------->|
19702 t t
19703 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19704 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19705 |<------ Tt ------->|
19706
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019707 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019708 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019709 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19710 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19711 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019712 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019713 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19714 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19715 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19716 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019717
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019718 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19719 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19720 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019721 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19722 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19723 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19724 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19725 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19726 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019727
19728 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19729 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19730 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19731 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19732 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19733 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19734 request typed by hand during a test.
19735
19736 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19737 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019738 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019739 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19740 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19741 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19742 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019743
19744 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19745 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19746 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19747 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19748 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19749
19750 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19751 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19752 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19753 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19754 connection never established.
19755
19756 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19757 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19758 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19759 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19760 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19761 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19762 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19763 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19764 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19765 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19766 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19767
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019768 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19769 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19770 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19771 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19772 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19773 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19774
19775 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19776
19777 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19778 "Ta" can never be negative.
19779
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019780 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19781 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019782 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19783 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019784 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019785
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019786 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019787
19788 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019789 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19790 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019791
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019792 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19793 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19794 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19795 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19796 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19797 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19798 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19799 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019801These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19802protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19803that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019804due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19805"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19806that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019807
19808Most common cases :
19809
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019810 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19811 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19812 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19813 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19814 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19815 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19816 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19817 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19818 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19819 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19820 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019821 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019822
19823 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19824 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19825 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19826 of ms on remote networks.
19827
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019828 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19829 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19830 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019831
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019832 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19833 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19834 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19835 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19836 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19837 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19838 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19839 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19840 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019841
19842Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019844 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019845 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019846 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019847
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019848 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019849 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19850 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19851
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019852 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019853 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19854 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19855 flags.
19856
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019857 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19858 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019859 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19860 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19861 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19862 the client connection was maintained open.
19863
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019864 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019865 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019866 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019867 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19868
19869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198708.5. Session state at disconnection
19871-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019872
19873TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19874"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
198752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19876each of which has a special meaning :
19877
19878 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19879 session to terminate :
19880
19881 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19882
19883 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19884 server explicitly refused it.
19885
19886 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19887 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19888 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19889 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019890 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019891
19892 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19893 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019894
19895 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19896 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19897 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19898 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19899 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19900
19901 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19902 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19903 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19904 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19905 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19906
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019907 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19908 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19909
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019910 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19911 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19912 backup connections when going up.
19913
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019914 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19915
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019916 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19917 send or receive data.
19918
19919 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19920 send or receive data.
19921
19922 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19923 with nothing left in the buffers.
19924
19925 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19926
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019927 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019928 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19929
19930 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19931 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19932 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19933 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19934 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19935
19936 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19937 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19938
19939 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19940 server (HTTP only).
19941
19942 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19943
19944 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19945 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19946 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19947
19948 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19949 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19950 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19951
19952 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19953
19954 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19955 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19956
19957 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19958 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19959 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19960
19961 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19962 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019963 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19964 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019965
19966 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19967 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19968 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19969 another server.
19970
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019971 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019972 server.
19973
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019974 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19975 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19976 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19977 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19978
19979 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19980 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19981 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19982 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19983
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019984 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19985 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19986 "use-server" rule).
19987
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019988 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19989
19990 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19991 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19992
19993 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19994
19995 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19996 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19997 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19998
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019999 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20000 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020001 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020002 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20003 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20004
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020005 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20006
20007 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20008 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20009
20010 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20011
20012 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20013
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020014The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20015was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20017starvation, attacks, etc...
20018
20019The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20020alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20021easier finding and understanding.
20022
20023 Flags Reason
20024
20025 -- Normal termination.
20026
20027 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20028 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20029 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20030 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20031
20032 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20033 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20034 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20035 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20036 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20037 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020038
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020039 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20040 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020041 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042
20043 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20044 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20045 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20046
20047 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20048 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20049 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20050 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20051 the server takes too long to respond.
20052
20053 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20054 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20055 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20056 long a time to respond.
20057
20058 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20059 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20060 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20061 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020062 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20063 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020064
20065 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20066 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20067 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20068 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20069 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020070 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020071 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20072 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20073 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20074 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20075 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20076 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20077 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20078 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020079 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020080 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20081 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20082 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020083
20084 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20085 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020086 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20087 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20088 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20089 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020090
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020091 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20092 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020094 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020095 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20096 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020097 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020098 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20099 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20100
20101 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20102 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20103 503 or 504 here.
20104
20105 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20106 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20107 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20108 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20109 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20110
20111 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20112 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020113 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020114 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20115 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20116
20117 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20118 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20119 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20120 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20121 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20122 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20123 between haproxy and the server.
20124
20125 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20126 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20127 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20128 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20129 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20130 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20131 solution is to fix the application.
20132
20133 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20134 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20135 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20136 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20137 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20138 external attacks.
20139
20140 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombsdab4ba62021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020141 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020142 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020143 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20144 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20145
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020146 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20147 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20148 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020149 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020150 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020152 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20153 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20154 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20155 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020156 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20157 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20158 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20159 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20160 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020161
20162 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20163 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20164 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20165 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20166
20167 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20168 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20169 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20170 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20171
20172 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20173 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20174 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20175 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20176
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020177The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20178persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20179important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20180re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20181
20182 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20183
20184 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20185 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20186 set on a GET request.
20187
20188 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20189 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020190 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020191 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20192
20193 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20194 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20195 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20196
20197 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20198 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20199 already got a cookie.
20200
20201 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20202 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20203 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20204 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20205 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20206
20207 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20208 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20209 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20210
20211 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20212 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20213 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20214
20215 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20216 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20217
20218 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20219 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20220 then advertised in the response.
20221
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202238.6. Non-printable characters
20224-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020225
20226In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20227consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20228converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20229prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20230being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20231escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20232is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20233'}' when logging headers.
20234
20235Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20236issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20237containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20238
20239Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20240the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20241performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20242
20243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202448.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20245---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020246
20247Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20248achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020249section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020250cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20251the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20252the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020253locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020254not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20255user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20256a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20257wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20258
20259 Examples :
20260 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20261 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20262
20263 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20264 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20265
20266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202678.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20268---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020269
20270Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20271proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20272the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20273server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20274
20275Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20276response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020277section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020278
20279It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020280time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20281appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020282are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20283and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20284follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20285request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20286in the logs.
20287
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020288As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20289frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20290an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20291
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020292 Example :
20293 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20294 listen proxy-out
20295 mode http
20296 option httplog
20297 option logasap
20298 log global
20299 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20300
20301 # log the name of the virtual server
20302 capture request header Host len 20
20303
20304 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20305 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20306
20307 # log the beginning of the referrer
20308 capture request header Referer len 20
20309
20310 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20311 capture response header Server len 20
20312
20313 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20314 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20315
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020316 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020317 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20318
20319 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20320 capture response header Via len 20
20321
20322 # log the URL location during a redirection
20323 capture response header Location len 20
20324
20325 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20326 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20327 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20328 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20329 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20330
20331 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20332 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20333 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20334 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020335 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020336
20337 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20338 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20339 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20340 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20341 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020342 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343
20344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203458.9. Examples of logs
20346---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347
20348These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20349them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20350reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20351
20352 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20353 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20354 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20355
20356 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20357 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20358
20359 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20360 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20361 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20362
20363 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20364 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20365
20366 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20367 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20368 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20369
20370 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020371 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020372 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20373 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20374
20375 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20376 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20377 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20378
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020379 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20380 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20381 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20382 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20383 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20384 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385
20386 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020387 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020388
20389 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20390 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20391 Nothing was sent to any server.
20392
20393 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20394 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20395
20396 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20397 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020398 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399 send a 408 return code to the client.
20400
20401 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20402 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20403
20404 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20405 5 seconds ("c----").
20406
20407 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20408 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020409 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020410
20411 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020412 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020413 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20414 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20415 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20416 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20417 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020418
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020419
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200204209. Supported filters
20421--------------------
20422
20423Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20424accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20425unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20426
20427See also : "filter"
20428
204299.1. Trace
20430----------
20431
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020432filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020433
20434 Arguments:
20435 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20436 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20437
20438 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20439 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20440 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20441 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20442
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020443 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020444 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20445 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20446 amount of the parsed data.
20447
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020448 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020449
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020450This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20451callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20452information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20453filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20454
20455Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20456tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20457a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20458
20459
204609.2. HTTP compression
20461---------------------
20462
20463filter compression
20464
20465The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20466keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020467when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20468fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20469done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20470explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20471filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20472listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20473order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020474
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020475See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20476 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020477
20478
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200204799.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20480--------------------------------------------
20481
20482filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20483
20484 Arguments :
20485
20486 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20487 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20488 parsed.
20489
20490 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20491 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20492 part must be placed in its own scope.
20493
20494The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20495external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020496streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020497exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20498also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20499
20500SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20501the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20502
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020503For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020504"doc/SPOE.txt".
20505
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100205069.4. Cache
20507----------
20508
20509filter cache <name>
20510
20511 Arguments :
20512
20513 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20514
20515The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20516"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020517cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020518other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20519case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20520is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20521filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020522listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20523order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020524
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020525See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20526 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20527
20528
205299.5. Fcgi-app
20530-------------
20531
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020532filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020533
20534 Arguments :
20535
20536 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20537
20538The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20539request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20540reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20541used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20542implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20543used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20544fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20545used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20546order.
20547
20548See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20549 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20550
20551
2055210. FastCGI applications
20553-------------------------
20554
20555HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20556feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20557the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20558FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20559servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20560FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20561backend.
20562
20563HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20564application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20565connection.
20566
2056710.1. Setup
20568-----------
20569
2057010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20571--------------------------
20572
20573fcgi-app <name>
20574 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20575 document root must be defined.
20576
20577acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20578 Declare or complete an access list.
20579
20580 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20581 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20582 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20583 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20584 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20585
20586docroot <path>
20587 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20588 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20589 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20590
20591index <script-name>
20592 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20593 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20594 is an optional setting.
20595
20596 Example :
20597 index index.php
20598
20599log-stderr global
20600log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagnerf2f5c4e2020-12-17 22:22:32 +010020601 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020602 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20603
20604 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20605 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20606
20607pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20608 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20609 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20610 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20611
20612 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20613 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20614 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20615 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20616
20617 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20618 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20619
20620path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020621 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020622 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20623 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20624 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20625 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20626 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20627 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20628 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020629
20630 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020631 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020632 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20633 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20634 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20635 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020636
20637 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020638 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20639 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020640
20641option get-values
20642no option get-values
20643 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20644
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020645 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020646 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20647
20648 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20649 application will accept.
20650
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020651 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20652 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020653
20654 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020655 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020656 option is disabled.
20657
20658 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20659 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20660 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20661 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20662 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20663 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20664
20665option keep-conn
20666no option keep-conn
20667 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20668 sending a response.
20669
20670 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20671 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20672
20673option max-reqs <reqs>
20674 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20675 accept.
20676
20677 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20678 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20679 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20680 to 1.
20681
20682option mpxs-conns
20683no option mpxs-conns
20684 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20685
20686 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20687 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20688
20689set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20690 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20691 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20692 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20693 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20694
20695 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20696 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20697 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20698
20699 Example :
20700 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20701 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20702
20703 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20704
20705
2070610.1.2. Proxy section
20707---------------------
20708
20709use-fcgi-app <name>
20710 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20711
20712 Arguments :
20713 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20714
20715 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20716 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20717 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20718 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20719 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20720
20721 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20722 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20723 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20724 application are evaluated.
20725
20726
2072710.1.3. Example
20728---------------
20729
20730 frontend front-http
20731 mode http
20732 bind *:80
20733 bind *:
20734
20735 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20736 default_backend back-static
20737
20738 backend back-static
20739 mode http
20740 server www A.B.C.D:80
20741
20742 backend back-dynamic
20743 mode http
20744 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20745 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20746
20747 fcgi-app php-fpm
20748 log-stderr global
20749 option keep-conn
20750
20751 docroot /var/www/my-app
20752 index index.php
20753 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20754
20755
2075610.2. Default parameters
20757------------------------
20758
20759A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20760the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020761script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020762applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20763
20764 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20765 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20766 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20767 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20768 | | |
20769 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20770 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20771 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20772 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20773 | | application. |
20774 | | |
20775 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20776 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20777 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20778 | | |
20779 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20780 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20781 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20782 | | the application's configuration. |
20783 | | |
20784 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20785 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20786 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20787 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20788 | | |
20789 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20790 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20791 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20792 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20793 | | be defined. |
20794 | | |
20795 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20796 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20797 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20798 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20799 | | is not set too. |
20800 | | |
20801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20802 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20803 | | set. |
20804 | | |
20805 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20806 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20807 | | the request. |
20808 | | |
20809 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20810 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20811 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20812 | | |
20813 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20814 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20815 | | script to process the request. |
20816 | | |
20817 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20818 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20819 | | |
20820 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20821 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20822 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20823 | | |
20824 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20825 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20826 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20827 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20828 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20829 | | |
20830 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20831 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20832 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20833 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20834 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20835 | | side. |
20836 | | |
20837 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20838 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20839 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20840 | | connected to. |
20841 | | |
20842 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20843 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20844 | | |
20845 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20846 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20847 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20848 | | |
20849 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20850
20851
2085210.3. Limitations
20853------------------
20854
20855The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20856way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20857during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20858establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20859application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20860or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20861message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20862these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20863and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20864
20865Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20866request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20867requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20868
20869About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20870into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20871fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20872"http-request" ones.
20873
20874Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20875FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20876processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20877must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20878here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020880/*
20881 * Local variables:
20882 * fill-column: 79
20883 * End:
20884 */